blob: 69dfbe7bbca19ddcb315751a2f1790582d872cb7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8747b6d2015-03-11 23:57:23 +01007 2015/03/11
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100489 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100490 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100491 - tune.lua.session-timeout
492 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100493 - tune.maxaccept
494 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200495 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200496 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200497 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100498 - tune.rcvbuf.client
499 - tune.rcvbuf.server
500 - tune.sndbuf.client
501 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100502 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100503 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200504 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100505 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200506 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100507 - tune.zlib.memlevel
508 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100509
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200510 * Debugging
511 - debug
512 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516------------------------------------
517
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200518ca-base <dir>
519 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200520 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
521 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200522
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523chroot <jail dir>
524 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
525 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
526 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
527 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
528 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
529 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100530
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100531cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
532 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
533 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
534 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100535 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
536 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
537 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
538 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
539 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
540 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
541 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
542 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
543 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
544 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100545
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200546crt-base <dir>
547 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
548 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
549 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551daemon
552 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
553 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
554 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
555
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900556external-check
557 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
558 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
559 See "option external-check".
560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561gid <number>
562 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
563 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
564 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100565 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
566 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100568
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569group <group name>
570 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
571 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200573log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
575 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 configured with "log global".
577
578 <address> can be one of:
579
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100580 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100581 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
582 port).
583
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100584 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
585 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
586 port).
587
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100588 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
589 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
590 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
591 writeable).
592
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100593 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
594 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
595 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
596 in Bourne shell.
597
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200598 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
599 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
600 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
601 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
602 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
603 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
604 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
605 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
606 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
607 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
608 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
609
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100610 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611
612 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
613 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
614 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
615
616 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200617 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
618 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
619 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
620 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
621 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
622 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200624 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100626log-send-hostname [<string>]
627 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
628 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
629 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
630 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
631 the logs.
632
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000633log-tag <string>
634 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
635 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
636 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100637 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000638
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100639lua-load <file>
640 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
641 used multiple times.
642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643nbproc <number>
644 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
645 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
646 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
647 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
648 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
649
650pidfile <pidfile>
651 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
652 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
653 starting the process. See also "daemon".
654
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100655stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
657 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
658 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
659 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
660 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
661 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100662 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200663 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
664 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200665
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100666ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300669 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100670 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
671 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
672 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
673 "bind" keyword for more information.
674
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100675ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
677 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
678 keyword to see available options.
679
680 Example:
681 global
682 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
683
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100684ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
685 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
686 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300687 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100688 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
689 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
690 information.
691
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100692ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
694 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
695 keyword to see available options.
696
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100697ssl-server-verify [none|required]
698 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
699 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
700 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
701
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200702stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
703 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
704 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
705 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
706 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200707
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200708 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
709 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
710 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200711
712stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
713 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
714 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100715 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200716
717stats maxconn <connections>
718 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
719 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
720
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721uid <number>
722 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
723 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
724 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
725 one. See also "gid" and "user".
726
727ulimit-n <number>
728 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
729 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
730 option.
731
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100732unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
733 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
734
735 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
736 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
737 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
738 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
739 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
740 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
741 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
742 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
743 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
744 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
745
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746user <user name>
747 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
748 See also "uid" and "group".
749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200750node <name>
751 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
752
753 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
754 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
755 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
756 traffic.
757
758description <text>
759 Add a text that describes the instance.
760
761 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
762 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
763 "<" and ">" characters.
764
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767-----------------------
768
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200769max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
770 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
771 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
772 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
773 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
774 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
775 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
776 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
777 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
778
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779maxconn <number>
780 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
781 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
782 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200783 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
784 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
785 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
786 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100787 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
788 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
789 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
790 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
791 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200793maxconnrate <number>
794 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
795 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
796 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
797 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
798 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
799 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
800 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
801 fairness.
802
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100803maxcomprate <number>
804 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300805 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100806 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
807 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
808 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
809 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
810 default value.
811
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100812maxcompcpuusage <number>
813 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
814 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
815 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
816 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
817 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
818 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
819 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
820 process down and from introducing high latencies.
821
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100822maxpipes <number>
823 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
824 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
825 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
826 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
827 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
828 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
829
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200830maxsessrate <number>
831 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
832 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
833 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
834 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
835 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
836 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
837 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
838 fairness.
839
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200840maxsslconn <number>
841 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
842 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
843 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
844 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
845 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
846 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
847 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100848 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
849 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
850 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
851 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
852 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
853 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
854 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200855
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200856maxsslrate <number>
857 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
858 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
859 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
860 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
861 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
862 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
863 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
864 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
865 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
866 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
867
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100868maxzlibmem <number>
869 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
870 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
871 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100872 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
873 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
874 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
875
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200876noepoll
877 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
878 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100879 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200880
881nokqueue
882 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
883 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
884 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
885
886nopoll
887 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
888 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100889 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100890 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200891
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100892nosplice
893 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
894 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
895 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100896 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100897 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
898 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
899 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
900 "option splice-response".
901
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300902nogetaddrinfo
903 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
904 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
905
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200906spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900907 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
908 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
909 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
910 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
911 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
912 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200913
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100914tune.buffers.limit <number>
915 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
916 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
917 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
918 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
919 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
920 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
921 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
922 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
923 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
924 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
925 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
926 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
927 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
928 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
929 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
930
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100931tune.buffers.reserve <number>
932 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
933 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
934 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
935 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
936
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200937tune.bufsize <number>
938 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
939 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
940 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
941 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
942 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
943 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
944 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
945 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400946 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
947 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
948 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200949
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200950tune.chksize <number>
951 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
952 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
953 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
954 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
955 checks whenever possible.
956
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100957tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
958 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
959 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
960 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
961 this value. The default value is 1.
962
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100963tune.http.cookielen <number>
964 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
965 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
966 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
967 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
968 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
969 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
970 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
971 to change this value.
972
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200973tune.http.maxhdr <number>
974 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
975 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
976 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
977 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
978 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
979 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
980 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
981 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
982 limit too high.
983
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100984tune.idletimer <timeout>
985 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
986 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
987 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
988 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
989 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
990 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
991 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
992 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
993 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
994
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100995tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
996 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
997 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
998 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
999 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1000 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1001 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1002 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1003
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001004tune.lua.maxmem
1005 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1006 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1007 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1008 memory.
1009
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001010tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1011 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1012 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1013 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1014 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1015 4s.
1016
1017tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1018 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1019 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1020 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1021 check servers.
1022
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001023tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001024 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1025 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1026 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1027 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1028 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1029 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1030 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1031 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1032 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1033 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001034
1035tune.maxpollevents <number>
1036 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1037 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1038 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1039 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1040 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1041
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001042tune.maxrewrite <number>
1043 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1044 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1045 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1046 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1047 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1048 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1049 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1050 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1051 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1052 bufsize.
1053
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001054tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1055 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1056 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1057 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1058 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1059 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1060 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1061 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1062 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1063 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1064 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1065 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1066 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1067 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1068 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1069 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1070 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1071 setting this parameter to 0.
1072
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001073tune.pipesize <number>
1074 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1075 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1076 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1077 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1078 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1079 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1080
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001081tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1082tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1083 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1084 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1085 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1086 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1087 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1088 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1089 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1090
1091tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1092tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1093 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1094 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1095 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1096 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1097 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1098 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1099 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1100 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1101 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1102 notifying haproxy again.
1103
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001104tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001105 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1106 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1107 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001108 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001109 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1110 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1111 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1112 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1113 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001114 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1115 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001116
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001117tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1118 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1119 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1120 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1121 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1122 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1123 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1124
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001125tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1126 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001127 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001128 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1129 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1130 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1131 being used for too long.
1132
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001133tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1134 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1135 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1136 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1137 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1138 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1139 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1140 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1141 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1142 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1143 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001144 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1145 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001146
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001147tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1148 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1149 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1150 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1151 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1152 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1153 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1154 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1155 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1156
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001157tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1158 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001159 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001160 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1161 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1162 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1163
1164tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1165 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1166 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1167 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1168 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011703.3. Debugging
1171--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001172
1173debug
1174 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1175 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1176 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1177 system startup.
1178
1179quiet
1180 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1181 line argument "-q".
1182
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011843.4. Userlists
1185--------------
1186It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1187http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1188it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1189
1190userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001191 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001192 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1193
1194group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001195 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001196 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1197 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001199user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1200 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001201 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1202 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001203 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1204 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001205 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001206 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001207
1208
1209 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001210 userlist L1
1211 group G1 users tiger,scott
1212 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001213
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001214 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1215 user scott insecure-password elgato
1216 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001217
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001218 userlist L2
1219 group G1
1220 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001221
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001222 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1223 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1224 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001225
1226 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001227
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001228
12293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001230----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001231It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1232haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1233pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1234identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1235or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1236Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1237known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1238the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1239process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1240during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1241tables.
1242
1243peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001244 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001245 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1246
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001247disabled
1248 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1249 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1250 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1251
1252enable
1253 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001255peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1256 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1257 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1258 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1259 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1260 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1261 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1262
1263 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1264 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1265
1266 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1267 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1268 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1269 across all peers.
1270
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001271 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1272 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1273 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1274
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001275 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001276 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001277 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1278 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1279 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001280
1281 backend mybackend
1282 mode tcp
1283 balance roundrobin
1284 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1285 stick on src
1286
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001287 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1288 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001289
1290
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012913.6. Mailers
1292------------
1293It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1294If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1295in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1296
1297mailer <mailersect>
1298 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1299 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1300
1301mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1302 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1303
1304 Example:
1305 mailers mymailers
1306 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1307 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1308
1309 backend mybackend
1310 mode tcp
1311 balance roundrobin
1312
1313 email-alert mailers mymailers
1314 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1315 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1316
1317 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1318 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1319
1320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001324Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1325 - defaults <name>
1326 - frontend <name>
1327 - backend <name>
1328 - listen <name>
1329
1330A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1331its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1332section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001333section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001334
1335A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1336connections.
1337
1338A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1339to forward incoming connections.
1340
1341A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1342parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1343
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1345'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1346case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1347
1348Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1349logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1350proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1351However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1352name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1353
1354Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1355and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001356bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001357protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1358modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1359arbitrary criteria.
1360
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001361In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1362a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1363the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1364
1365 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1366 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1367 between responses and new requests.
1368
1369 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1370 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1371 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1372 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1373
1374 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1375 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1376 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1377
1378 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1379 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1380 client-facing connection remains open.
1381
1382 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1383 after the end of the response.
1384
1385The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1386frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1387following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1388weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1389
1390 Backend mode
1391
1392 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1393 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1394 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1395 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1396 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1397 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1398 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1399 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1400 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1401 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1402 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001404
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1407--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001409The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1410limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1411they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1412limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001413marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001414option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001415and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1416with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1417specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001418
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001420 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1421------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1422acl - X X X
1423appsession - - X X
1424backlog X X X -
1425balance X - X X
1426bind - X X -
1427bind-process X X X X
1428block - X X X
1429capture cookie - X X -
1430capture request header - X X -
1431capture response header - X X -
1432clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001433compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001434contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1435cookie X - X X
1436default-server X - X X
1437default_backend X X X -
1438description - X X X
1439disabled X X X X
1440dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001441email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001442email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001443email-alert mailers X X X X
1444email-alert myhostname X X X X
1445email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001446enabled X X X X
1447errorfile X X X X
1448errorloc X X X X
1449errorloc302 X X X X
1450-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1451errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001452force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453fullconn X - X X
1454grace X X X X
1455hash-type X - X X
1456http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001457http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001458http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001460http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001461http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001463ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001464log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001465log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001466log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001467max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001468maxconn X X X -
1469mode X X X X
1470monitor fail - X X -
1471monitor-net X X X -
1472monitor-uri X X X -
1473option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1474option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1475option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1476option allbackups (*) X - X X
1477option checkcache (*) X - X X
1478option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1479option contstats (*) X X X -
1480option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1481option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1482option forceclose (*) X X X X
1483-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1484option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001485option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001486option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001487option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001488option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001489option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001490option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001491option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001492option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1493option httpchk X - X X
1494option httpclose (*) X X X X
1495option httplog X X X X
1496option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001497option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001498option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001499option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001500option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1501option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1502option logasap (*) X X X -
1503option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001504option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001505option nolinger (*) X X X X
1506option originalto X X X X
1507option persist (*) X - X X
1508option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001509option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001510option smtpchk X - X X
1511option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1512option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1513option splice-request (*) X X X X
1514option splice-response (*) X X X X
1515option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1516option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1517-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001518option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001519option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1520option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1521option tcpka X X X X
1522option tcplog X X X X
1523option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001524external-check command X - X X
1525external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001526persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1527rate-limit sessions X X X -
1528redirect - X X X
1529redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1530redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1531reqadd - X X X
1532reqallow - X X X
1533reqdel - X X X
1534reqdeny - X X X
1535reqiallow - X X X
1536reqidel - X X X
1537reqideny - X X X
1538reqipass - X X X
1539reqirep - X X X
1540reqisetbe - X X X
1541reqitarpit - X X X
1542reqpass - X X X
1543reqrep - X X X
1544-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1545reqsetbe - X X X
1546reqtarpit - X X X
1547retries X - X X
1548rspadd - X X X
1549rspdel - X X X
1550rspdeny - X X X
1551rspidel - X X X
1552rspideny - X X X
1553rspirep - X X X
1554rsprep - X X X
1555server - - X X
1556source X - X X
1557srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001558stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001559stats auth X - X X
1560stats enable X - X X
1561stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001562stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001563stats realm X - X X
1564stats refresh X - X X
1565stats scope X - X X
1566stats show-desc X - X X
1567stats show-legends X - X X
1568stats show-node X - X X
1569stats uri X - X X
1570-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1571stick match - - X X
1572stick on - - X X
1573stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001574stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001575stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001576tcp-check connect - - X X
1577tcp-check expect - - X X
1578tcp-check send - - X X
1579tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001580tcp-request connection - X X -
1581tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001582tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001583tcp-response content - - X X
1584tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001585timeout check X - X X
1586timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001587timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001588timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1589timeout connect X - X X
1590timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1591timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1592timeout http-request X X X X
1593timeout queue X - X X
1594timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001595timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001596timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1597timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001598timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001599transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001600unique-id-format X X X -
1601unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001602use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001603use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001604------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1605 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016084.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1609---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610
1611This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1612
1613
1614acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1615 Declare or complete an access list.
1616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1617 no | yes | yes | yes
1618 Example:
1619 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1620 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1621 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001623 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001624
1625
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001626appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1627 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1630 no | no | yes | yes
1631 Arguments :
1632 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1633 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1634
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001635 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001636 checked in each cookie value.
1637
1638 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1639 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1640 milliseconds.
1641
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001642 request-learn
1643 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1644 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1645 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1646 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1647 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1648 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1649
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001650 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1651 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1652 data following this prefix.
1653
1654 Example :
1655 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1656
1657 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1658 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1659
1660 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1661 2 modes are currently supported :
1662 - path-parameters :
1663 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1664 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1665 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1666 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1667 - query-string :
1668 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1669 query string.
1670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001671 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1672 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1673 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1674 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001675 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1676 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1677 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001678 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1679 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1680
1681 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1682
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001683 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1684 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1685 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001687 Example :
1688 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1689
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001690 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1691 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001692
1693
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001694backlog <conns>
1695 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1697 yes | yes | yes | no
1698 Arguments :
1699 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1700 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001701 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001702
1703 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1704 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1705 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1706 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1707 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1708 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1709 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1710 backlog parameter.
1711
1712 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1713 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1714 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1715
1716 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1717
1718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001720balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001721 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1723 yes | no | yes | yes
1724 Arguments :
1725 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1726 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1727 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1728 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1729
1730 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1731 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1732 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1733 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001734 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001735 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001736 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1737 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1738 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1739 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1740 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1741 it, so that you don't worry.
1742
1743 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1744 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1745 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1746 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1747 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1748 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1749 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1750 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001752 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1753 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1754 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1755 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1756 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1757 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1758 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1759 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1760
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001761 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001762 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001763 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1764 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001765 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001766 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1767 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1768 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1769 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1770 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001771 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1772 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1773 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1774 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1775 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1776 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001778 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1779 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1780 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1781 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1782 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1783 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1784 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1785 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001786 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001787 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001788 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1789 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1790 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001791
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001792 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1793 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1794 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1795 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1796 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1797 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1798 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1799 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1800 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1801 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1802 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1803 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001805 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001806 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1807 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1808 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1809 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1810 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1811 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1812 URIs start with a leading "/".
1813
1814 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1815 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1816 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1817 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001820 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1821
1822 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001823 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1824 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001825 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1826 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1827 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1828 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001829 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001830 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1831 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001832
1833 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1834 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1835 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1836 server will receive the request.
1837
1838 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1839 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1840 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1841 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1842 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001843 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1844 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1845 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001847 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1848 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1849 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1850 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1851 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001853 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001854 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1855 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1856 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1857
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001858 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1859 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1860 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1861
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001862 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001863 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001864 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1865 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1866 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1867 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1868 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1869 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001870 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001871 used instead.
1872
1873 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1874 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1875 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1876 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1877
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001878 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1879 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1880 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1881
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001882 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001883
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001885 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1886 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001887
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001888 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1889 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1890 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001891
1892 Examples :
1893 balance roundrobin
1894 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001895 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001896 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1897 balance hdr(host)
1898 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001899
1900 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1901 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001903 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001904 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1905 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1906 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1907 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1908
1909 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1910 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1911 defaults to 16 kB.
1912
1913 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1914 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1915
1916 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1917 Round Robin.
1918
1919 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1920 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1921 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1922 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1923
1924 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1925
1926 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001927 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001928 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1929 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1930 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001931
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001932 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1933 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934
1935
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001936bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1937bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1940 no | yes | yes | no
1941 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001942 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1943 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1944 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1945 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001946 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001947 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1948 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1949 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1950 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1951 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1952 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1953 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001954 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1955 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1956 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1957 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1958 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1959 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1960 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001961 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1962 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1963 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001964 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1965 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1966 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1967 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001968
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001969 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1970 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001971 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1972 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1973 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001974 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1975 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1976 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1977 the range.
1978
1979 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1980 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1981 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1982 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1983 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1984 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1985 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001986 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001987 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001989 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1990 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1991 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1992 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1993 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1994 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1995 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1996 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1997
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001998 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1999 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2000 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2001 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002002
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2004 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2005 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2006 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2007 in a frontend.
2008
2009 Example :
2010 listen http_proxy
2011 bind :80,:443
2012 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002013 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002014
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002015 listen http_https_proxy
2016 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002017 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002018
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002019 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2020 bind ipv6@:80
2021 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2022 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2023
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002024 listen external_bind_app1
2025 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
2026
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002027 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002028 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029
2030
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002031bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002032 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2034 yes | yes | yes | yes
2035 Arguments :
2036 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2037 may be used to override a default value.
2038
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002039 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002040 option may be combined with other numbers.
2041
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002042 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002043 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2044 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2045 missing from all processes.
2046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002047 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002048 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002049 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2050 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2051 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2052 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002053
2054 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2055 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2056 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2057 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2058 and 'even' instances.
2059
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002060 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2061 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2062 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2063 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002064
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002065 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2066 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2067
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002068 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2069 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2070 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2071
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002072 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2073 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2074
2075 Example :
2076 listen app_ip1
2077 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002078 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002079
2080 listen app_ip2
2081 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002082 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002083
2084 listen management
2085 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002086 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002087
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002088 listen management
2089 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2090 bind-process 1-4
2091
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002092 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002093
2094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095block { if | unless } <condition>
2096 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2098 no | yes | yes | yes
2099
2100 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2101 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002102 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002103 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002104 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2105 "block" statements per instance.
2106
2107 Example:
2108 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2109 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2110 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2111 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002113 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114
2115
2116capture cookie <name> len <length>
2117 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2119 no | yes | yes | no
2120 Arguments :
2121 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2122 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2123 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2124 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2125 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2126
2127 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2128 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2129 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2130 right if it exceeds <length>.
2131
2132 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2133 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2134 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2135 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2136
2137 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2138 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2139 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2140
2141 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2142 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2143 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002144 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2145 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2146 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147
2148 Example:
2149 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2150
2151 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002152 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153
2154
2155capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002156 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2158 no | yes | yes | no
2159 Arguments :
2160 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002161 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002162 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2163 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2164 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2165
2166 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2167 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2168 it exceeds <length>.
2169
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002170 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2172 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002173 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2174 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2175 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2176 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002177 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002178 environments to find where the request came from.
2179
2180 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2181 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2182 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2183 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002184
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002185 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2186 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2187 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2188 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2189 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190
2191 Example:
2192 capture request header Host len 15
2193 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2194 capture request header Referrer len 15
2195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002196 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197 about logging.
2198
2199
2200capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002201 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2203 no | yes | yes | no
2204 Arguments :
2205 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002206 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2208 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2209 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2210
2211 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2212 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2213 it exceeds <length>.
2214
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002215 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002216 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2217 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2218 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002219 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2220 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2221 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2222 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002224 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2225 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2226 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2227 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2228 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002229
2230 Example:
2231 capture response header Content-length len 9
2232 capture response header Location len 15
2233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002234 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235 about logging.
2236
2237
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002238clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002239 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2241 yes | yes | yes | no
2242 Arguments :
2243 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2244 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2245 as explained at the top of this document.
2246
2247 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2248 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2249 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2250 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2251 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2252 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2253 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2254 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002255 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002256 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2257 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2258
2259 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2260 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2261 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2262 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2263 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2264 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2265
2266 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2267 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2268
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002269 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2270 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002271
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002272compression algo <algorithm> ...
2273compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002274compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002275 Enable HTTP compression.
2276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2277 yes | yes | yes | yes
2278 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002279 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2280 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2281 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2282
2283 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002284 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2285 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2286 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002287
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002288 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2289 support for zlib was built in.
2290
2291 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2292 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2293 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2294 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2295 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2296 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002297
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002298 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2299 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2300 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2301 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2302 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2303 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2304 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2305 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002306
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002307 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002308 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002309 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2310 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2311 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2312 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2313 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002314
2315 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2316 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2317 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2318 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2319 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002320 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2321 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2322 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2323 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2324 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002325 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2326 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002327
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002328 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002329 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2330 "Accept-Encoding" header
2331 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002332 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002333 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2334 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002335 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2336 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2337 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2338 "multipart"
2339 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2340 header
2341 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2342 and later
2343 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2344 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002345
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002346 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2347 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002348
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002349 Examples :
2350 compression algo gzip
2351 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002353contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2356 yes | no | yes | yes
2357 Arguments :
2358 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2359 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2360 as explained at the top of this document.
2361
2362 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002363 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002364 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2366 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2367 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2368 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2369
2370 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2371 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2372 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2373 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2374 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2375 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2376
2377 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2378 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2379 instead.
2380
2381 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2382 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2383
2384
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002385cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002386 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2387 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002388 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2390 yes | no | yes | yes
2391 Arguments :
2392 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2393 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2394 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2395 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2396 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2397 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2398 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2399 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2400 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2401
2402 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2403 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2404 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2405 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2406 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2407 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2408 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2409 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2410 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2411 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2412 "insert" and "prefix".
2413
2414 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002415 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002416
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002417 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002418 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2419 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2420 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2421 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2422 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2423 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2424 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2425 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2426 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2427 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428
2429 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2430 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2431 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2432 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2433 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2434 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2435 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2436 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2437 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2438 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002439 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2440 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2441 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002443 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2444 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2445 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002446 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2447 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2448 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2449 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002450 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2451 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2452 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002453
2454 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2455 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2456 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2457 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2458 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2459 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2460 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2461 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2462 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2463
2464 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2465 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2466 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2467 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2468 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2469 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2470 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2471 persistence cookie in the cache.
2472 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2473
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002474 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2475 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2476 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2477 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2478 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2479 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2480 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2481 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2482 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2483 they logout.
2484
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002485 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2486 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2487 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2488 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2489
2490 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2491 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2492 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2493 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2494 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2495 this attribute.
2496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002497 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002498 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002499 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2500 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2501 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2502 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2503 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2504 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002505
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002506 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2507 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2508 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2509 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2510 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2511 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2512 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2513 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2514 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2515 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2516 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2517 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2518 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2519 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2520 the site.
2521
2522 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2523 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2524 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2525 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2526 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2527 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2528 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2529 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2530 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2531 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2532 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2533 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2534 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2535 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2536 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2537 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002539 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2540 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2541 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2542 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002544 Examples :
2545 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2546 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2547 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002548 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002549
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002550 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002551 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002552
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002554default-server [param*]
2555 Change default options for a server in a backend
2556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2557 yes | no | yes | yes
2558 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002559 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2560 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2561 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2562 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002564 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002565 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2566
2567 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570default_backend <backend>
2571 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2573 yes | yes | yes | no
2574 Arguments :
2575 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2576
2577 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2578 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2579 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2580 will catch all undetermined requests.
2581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002582 Example :
2583
2584 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2585 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2586 default_backend dynamic
2587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002588 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002591description <string>
2592 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2594 no | yes | yes | yes
2595 Arguments : string
2596
2597 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2598 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2599 it describes.
2600 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2601
2602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603disabled
2604 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2606 yes | yes | yes | yes
2607 Arguments : none
2608
2609 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2610 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2611 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2612 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2613 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2614 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2615 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2616
2617 See also : "enabled"
2618
2619
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002620dispatch <address>:<port>
2621 Set a default server address
2622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2623 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002624 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002625
2626 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2627 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2628 during start-up.
2629
2630 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2631 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2632 possible with normal servers.
2633
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002634 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002635 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2636 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2637 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2638 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2639
2640 See also : "server"
2641
2642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643enabled
2644 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2646 yes | yes | yes | yes
2647 Arguments : none
2648
2649 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2650 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2651
2652 See also : "disabled"
2653
2654
2655errorfile <code> <file>
2656 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2658 yes | yes | yes | yes
2659 Arguments :
2660 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002661 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2662 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002663
2664 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002665 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002666 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002667 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2668 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669
2670 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2671 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2672 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2673
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002674 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002676 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2677 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2678 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2679 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2680
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002681 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2682 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2683 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2684 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2685 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2686 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2689 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2690 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002691 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2693
2694 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2695
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002696 Example :
2697 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002698 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002699 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2700 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002702
2703errorloc <code> <url>
2704errorloc302 <code> <url>
2705 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2707 yes | yes | yes | yes
2708 Arguments :
2709 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002710 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002711
2712 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2713 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2714 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2715 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2716 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2717
2718 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2719 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2720 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2721
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002722 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2723
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002724 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2725 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2726 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2727 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2728 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2729 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2730 request.
2731
2732 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2733
2734
2735errorloc303 <code> <url>
2736 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2738 yes | yes | yes | yes
2739 Arguments :
2740 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2741 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2742
2743 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2744 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2745 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2746 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2747 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2748
2749 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2750 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2751 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2752
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002753 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2754
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002755 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2756 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2757 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2758 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002759 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002760
2761 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2762
2763
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002764email-alert from <emailaddr>
2765 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2766 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2767 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2768 yes | yes | yes | yes
2769
2770 Arguments :
2771
2772 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2773
2774 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2775 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2776
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002777 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2778 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2779
2780
2781email-alert level <level>
2782 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2783 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2785 yes | yes | yes | yes
2786
2787 Arguments :
2788
2789 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2790 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2791 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2792
2793 By default level is alert
2794
2795 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2796 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2797 for the proxy.
2798
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09002799 Alerts are sent when :
2800
2801 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
2802 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
2803 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
2804 is notice or lower
2805 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
2806 and a health check status update occurs
2807
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002808 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2809 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002810 section 3.6 about mailers.
2811
2812
2813email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2814 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2816 yes | yes | yes | yes
2817
2818 Arguments :
2819
2820 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2821
2822 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2823 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2824
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002825 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2826 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002827
2828
2829email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2830 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2831 mailers.
2832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 yes | yes | yes | yes
2834
2835 Arguments :
2836
2837 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2838
2839 By default the systems hostname is used.
2840
2841 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2842 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2843 for the proxy.
2844
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002845 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2846 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002847
2848
2849email-alert to <emailaddr>
2850 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2851 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2853 yes | yes | yes | yes
2854
2855 Arguments :
2856
2857 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2858
2859 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2860 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2861
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002862 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002863 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2864
2865
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002866force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2867 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2869 no | yes | yes | yes
2870
2871 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2872 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2873 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2874 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2875 marked down for maintenance operations.
2876
2877 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2878 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2879 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2880 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2881 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2882 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2883 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2884 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2885 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2886
2887 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2888 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2889 is used.
2890
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002891 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002892 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002893
2894
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002895fullconn <conns>
2896 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2898 yes | no | yes | yes
2899 Arguments :
2900 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2901 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2902
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002903 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002904 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002905 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002906 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2907 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2908 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2909 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2910 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002911 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002912
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002913 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2914 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002915 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2916 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2917 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002919 Example :
2920 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2921 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2922 # connections.
2923 backend dynamic
2924 fullconn 10000
2925 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2926 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2927
2928 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2929
2930
2931grace <time>
2932 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002934 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002935 Arguments :
2936 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2937 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2938 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2939
2940 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2941 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002942 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002943 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2944
2945 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2946 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2947 simplify it.
2948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002950hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002951 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2953 yes | no | yes | yes
2954 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002955 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2956 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002957
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002958 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2959 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2960 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2961 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2962 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2963 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2964 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2965 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2966 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2967 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002968
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002969 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2970 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2971 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2972 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2973 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2974 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2975 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2976 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2977 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2978 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2979 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2980 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2981 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002982 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2983 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002984
2985 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2986
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002987 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002988 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2989 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2990 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002991 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2992 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2993 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002994
2995 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2996 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002997 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2998 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2999 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3000 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3001
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003002 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3003 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3004 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3005 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3006 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3007 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3008 parameter.
3009
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003010 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3011 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3012 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3013 used on strings.
3014
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003015 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3016
3017 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3018 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3019 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3020 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3021 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3022 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3023 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3024 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3025 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3026 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3027 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3028 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003029
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003030 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3031 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3032 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003033
3034 See also : "balance", "server"
3035
3036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037http-check disable-on-404
3038 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003040 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041 Arguments : none
3042
3043 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3044 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3045 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3046 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3047 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3048 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3049 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3050 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003051 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3052 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3053 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3054
3055 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3056
3057
3058http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003059 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003061 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003062 Arguments :
3063 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3064 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003065 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003066 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3067 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3068 details on the supported keywords.
3069
3070 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3071 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3072 with the usual backslash ('\').
3073
3074 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3075 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3076 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3077 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3078 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3079
3080 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003081 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003082 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3083 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3084 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3085
3086 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003087 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003088 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3089 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3090 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3091 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3092
3093 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003094 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003095 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3096 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3097 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3098 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3099 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3100 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3101 trace).
3102
3103 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003104 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003105 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3106 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3107 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3108 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3109 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3110 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3111
3112 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3113 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3114 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3115 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3116 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3117 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3118 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3119 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3120
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003121 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3122 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3123 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3124
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003125 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3126 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3127
3128 Examples :
3129 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003130 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003131
3132 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003133 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003134
3135 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003136 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003137
3138 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003139 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003141 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003142
3143
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003144http-check send-state
3145 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3147 yes | no | yes | yes
3148 Arguments : none
3149
3150 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3151 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3152 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3153 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3154 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3155
3156 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3157 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3158 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3159 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3160 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003161 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3162 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3163 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3164
3165 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3166 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3167 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3168
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003169 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3170 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3171 checked in multiple backends.
3172
3173 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3174 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3175
3176 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3177 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3178 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3179 one fails.
3180
3181 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3182 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3183 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3184
3185 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3186 server's queue.
3187
3188 Example of a header received by the application server :
3189 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3190 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3191
3192 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3193
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003194http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003195 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003196 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003197 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3198 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003199 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3200 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003201 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3202 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3203 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003204 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003205 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3206 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003207 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003208 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003209 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3210
3211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3212 no | yes | yes | yes
3213
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003214 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3215 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3216 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3217 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3218 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003219
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003220 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3221 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3222 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3223
3224 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3225 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3226 are evaluated.
3227
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003228 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3229 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3230 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3231 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3232 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3233 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3234 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3235 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3236 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003237 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003238 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3239
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003240 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3241 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3242 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3243 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3244 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3245
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003246 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3247 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3248 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003249 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3250 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003251
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003252 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3253 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3254 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3255 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3256 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3257 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3258 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3259 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3260
3261 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3262 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3263 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003264 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3265 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003266
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003267 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3268 <name>.
3269
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003270 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3271 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3272 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3273 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3274 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3275 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3276 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3277 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3278
3279 Example:
3280
3281 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3282
3283 applied to:
3284
3285 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3286
3287 outputs:
3288
3289 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3290
3291 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3292
3293 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3294 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3295 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3296 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3297 header.
3298
3299 Example:
3300
3301 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3302
3303 applied to:
3304
3305 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3306
3307 outputs:
3308
3309 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3310
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003311 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3312 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3313 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3314 it.
3315
3316 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3317 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3318 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3319 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3320 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3321 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3322
3323 Example :
3324 # prepend the host name before the path
3325 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3326
3327 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3328 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3329 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3330 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3331 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3332 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3333 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3334 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3335
3336 Example :
3337 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3338 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3339
3340 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3341 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3342 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3343 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3344 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3345 "set-query".
3346
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003347 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3348 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3349 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3350 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3351 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3352 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3353 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3354 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3355
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003356 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3357 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3358 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3359 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3360 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3361 another equipment.
3362
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003363 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3364 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3365 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3366 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3367 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3368 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3369 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3370 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3371
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003372 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3373 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3374 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3375 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3376 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3377 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3378 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3379 admin privileges.
3380
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003381 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3382 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3383 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3384 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3385 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3386 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3387 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3388 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3389
3390 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3391 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3392 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3393 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3394 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3395 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3396
3397 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3398 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3399 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3400 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3401 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3402 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3403
3404 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3405 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3406 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3407 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3408 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3409 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3410 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3411 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3412 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3413
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003414 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3415 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3416 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3417 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3418 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3419 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3420 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3421 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3422 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3423 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3424 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3425 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3426
3427 These actions take one or two arguments :
3428 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3429 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3430 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3431 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3432
3433 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3434 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3435 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3436 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3437
3438 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3439 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3440 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3441 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3442 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3443 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3444 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3445 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3446
3447 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3448 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3449 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3450 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3451 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3452
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003453 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3454 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3455 function is documented in the API documentation.
3456
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003457 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3458
3459 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3460 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3461 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3462 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003463
3464 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003465 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3466 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3467 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003468
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003469 http-request allow if nagios
3470 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3471 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3472 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003473
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003474 Example:
3475 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003476 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003477
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003478 Example:
3479 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3480 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3481 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3482 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3483 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3484 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3485 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3486 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3487 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3488
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003489 Example:
3490 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3491 acl add path /addacl
3492 acl del path /delacl
3493
3494 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3495
3496 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3497 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3498
3499 Example:
3500 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3501 acl setmap path /setmap
3502 acl delmap path /delmap
3503
3504 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3505
3506 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3507 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3508
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003509 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3510 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003511
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003512http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003513 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003514 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3515 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003516 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3517 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3518 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3519 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003520 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3521 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003522 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003523 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003524 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3525
3526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3527 no | yes | yes | yes
3528
3529 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3530 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3531 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3532 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3533 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3534 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3535
3536 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3537 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3538 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3539 current section.
3540
3541 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3542 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3543 rules are evaluated.
3544
3545 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3546 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3547 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3548 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3549 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3550 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3551 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3552
3553 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3554 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3555 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3556 external users.
3557
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003558 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3559 <name>.
3560
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003561 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3562 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3563 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3564 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3565 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3566 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3567 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3568 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3569
3570 Example:
3571
3572 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3573
3574 applied to:
3575
3576 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3577
3578 outputs:
3579
3580 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3581
3582 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3583
3584 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3585 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3586 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3587 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3588 header.
3589
3590 Example:
3591
3592 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3593
3594 applied to:
3595
3596 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3597
3598 outputs:
3599
3600 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3601
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003602 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3603 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3604 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3605 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3606 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3607 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3608 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3609 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3610
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003611 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3612 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3613 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3614 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3615 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3616 another equipment.
3617
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003618 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3619 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3620 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3621 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3622 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3623 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3624 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3625 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3626
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003627 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3628 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3629 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3630 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3631 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3632 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3633 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3634 admin privileges.
3635
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003636 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3637 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3638 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3639 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3640 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3641 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3642 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3643 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3644
3645 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3646 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3647 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3648 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3649 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3650 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3651
3652 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3653 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3654 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3655 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3656 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3657 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3658
3659 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3660 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3661 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3662 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3663 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3664 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3665 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3666 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3667 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3668
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003669 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3670 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3671 function is documented in the API documentation.
3672
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003673 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3674
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003675 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003676 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3677 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3678 rules.
3679
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003680 Example:
3681 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3682
3683 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3684
3685 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3686 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3687
3688 Example:
3689 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3690
3691 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3692
3693 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3694 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3695
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003696 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3697 ACL usage.
3698
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003699
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003700http-send-name-header [<header>]
3701 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3702
3703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | no | yes | yes
3705
3706 Arguments :
3707
3708 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3709
3710 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3711 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3712 is added with the header string proved.
3713
3714 See also : "server"
3715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003716id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003717 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 no | yes | yes | yes
3720 Arguments : none
3721
3722 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3723 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3724 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003725
3726
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003727ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3728 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 no | yes | yes | yes
3731
3732 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3733 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3734 and running).
3735
3736 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3737 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3738 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003739 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003740 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3741
3742 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3743 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3744
3745 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3746 "unless" condition is met.
3747
3748 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3749
3750
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003751log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003752log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003753no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003754 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003757
3758 Prefix :
3759 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3760 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3761 prefix does not allow arguments.
3762
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003763 Arguments :
3764 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3765 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3766 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3767 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3768 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3769 parameter.
3770
3771 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3772 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3773
3774 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3775 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3776 standard syslog port).
3777
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003778 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3779 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3780 standard syslog port).
3781
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003782 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3783 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3784 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3785 appropriately writeable).
3786
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003787 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3788 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3789 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3790 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3791
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003792 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3793 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3794 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3795 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3796 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3797 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3798 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3799 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3800 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3801 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3802 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3803
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003804 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3805
3806 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3807 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3808 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3809
3810 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3811 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3812 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003813 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3814 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3815 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3816 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3817 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003818
3819 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3820
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003821 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3822 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3823 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003824
3825 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3826 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3827 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3828 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3829
3830 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3831 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003832
3833 Example :
3834 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003835 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3836 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003837 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3838
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003839
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003840log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003841 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003844
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003845 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3846 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3847 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3848 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3849 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003850
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003851log-tag <string>
3852 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3854 yes | yes | yes | yes
3855
3856 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3857 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3858 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3859 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3860 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3861 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3862 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3863 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3864 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003865
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003866max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3867 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3869 yes | no | yes | yes
3870
3871 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3872 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3873 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3874 servers.
3875
3876 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3877 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3878 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3879 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3880 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3881 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3882 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3883 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3884 picking a different server.
3885
3886 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3887 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3888 even if they have to be queued.
3889
3890 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3891 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3892
3893
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003894maxconn <conns>
3895 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3897 yes | yes | yes | no
3898 Arguments :
3899 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3900 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3901 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3902 closes.
3903
3904 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3905 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3906 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3907 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3908 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3909 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3910 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3911 properly tuned.
3912
3913 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3914 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3915 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3916
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003917 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003919 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3920
3921
3922mode { tcp|http|health }
3923 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3925 yes | yes | yes | yes
3926 Arguments :
3927 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3928 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3929 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3930 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3931
3932 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3933 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3934 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3935 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3936 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3937
3938 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003939 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3940 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3941 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3942 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3943 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3944 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3945 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003946
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003947 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3948 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3949 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003950
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003951 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003952 defaults http_instances
3953 mode http
3954
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003955 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003957
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003958monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003959 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3961 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003962 Arguments :
3963 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3964 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003965 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3967 backend and its backup.
3968
3969 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3970 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3971 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3972 servers in a list of backends.
3973
3974 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3975 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3976 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3977 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3978 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3979 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3980 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003981 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3982 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003983
3984 Example:
3985 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3988 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3989 monitor-uri /site_alive
3990 monitor fail if site_dead
3991
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003992 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003993
3994
3995monitor-net <source>
3996 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3998 yes | yes | yes | no
3999 Arguments :
4000 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4001 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4002 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4003 followed by a mask.
4004
4005 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4006 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004007 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004008 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4009
4010 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4011 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4012 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4013 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004014 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4015 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4016 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004017
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004018 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4019 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4020 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4021 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4022 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4023 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004024
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004025 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4026 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004027
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004028 Example :
4029 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4030 frontend www
4031 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4032
4033 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4034
4035
4036monitor-uri <uri>
4037 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 yes | yes | yes | no
4040 Arguments :
4041 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4042 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4043
4044 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4045 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4046 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4047 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4048 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4049 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4050 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4051 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4052
4053 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4054 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4055 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4056 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4057 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4058 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4059
4060 Example :
4061 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4062 frontend www
4063 mode http
4064 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4065
4066 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004068
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004069option abortonclose
4070no option abortonclose
4071 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4073 yes | no | yes | yes
4074 Arguments : none
4075
4076 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4077 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4078 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4079 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004080 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004081 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4082 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4083 encountered while delivering the response.
4084
4085 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4086 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4087 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4088 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4089 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4090 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004091 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004092 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004093 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004094 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4095 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4096 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4097
4098 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4099 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4100 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4101 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4102 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4103 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4104 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4105 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004106 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004107
4108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4110
4111 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4112
4113
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004114option accept-invalid-http-request
4115no option accept-invalid-http-request
4116 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4118 yes | yes | yes | no
4119 Arguments : none
4120
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004121 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004122 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4123 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4124 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4125 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4126 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4127 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4128 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004129 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4130 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4131 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4132 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4133 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004134 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004135 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4136 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4137 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004138
4139 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4140 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4141 been confirmed.
4142
4143 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4144 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004145 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4146 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004147 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4148
4149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4151
4152 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4153 stats socket.
4154
4155
4156option accept-invalid-http-response
4157no option accept-invalid-http-response
4158 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4160 yes | no | yes | yes
4161 Arguments : none
4162
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004163 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004164 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4165 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4166 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4167 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4168 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4169 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4170 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004171 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4172 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4173 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004174
4175 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4176 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4177 been confirmed.
4178
4179 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4180 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4181 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4182 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4183
4184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4186
4187 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4188 stats socket.
4189
4190
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004191option allbackups
4192no option allbackups
4193 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4195 yes | no | yes | yes
4196 Arguments : none
4197
4198 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4199 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4200 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4201 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4202 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4203 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4204 order between the backup servers anymore.
4205
4206 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4207 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4208
4209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4211
4212
4213option checkcache
4214no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004215 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | no | yes | yes
4218 Arguments : none
4219
4220 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4221 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004222 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004223 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4224 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004225 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004226
4227 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004228 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004229 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004230 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4231 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004232 to the client are :
4233 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004234 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004235 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004236 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4237 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4238 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4239 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4240 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4241 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4242 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4243 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4244 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4245 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4246 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4247
4248 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004249 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004250 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004251 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004252 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4253
4254 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4255 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004256 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004257 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4258
4259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4261
4262
4263option clitcpka
4264no option clitcpka
4265 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 yes | yes | yes | no
4268 Arguments : none
4269
4270 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4271 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4272 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4273 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4274
4275 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4276 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4277 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4278 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4279
4280 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4281 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4282 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4283 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4284 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4285
4286 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4287
4288 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4289 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4290 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4291
4292 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4293 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4294
4295 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4296
4297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004298option contstats
4299 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 yes | yes | yes | no
4302 Arguments : none
4303
4304 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4305 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4306 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4307 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4308 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4309 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4310 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4311
4312
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004313option dontlog-normal
4314no option dontlog-normal
4315 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4317 yes | yes | yes | no
4318 Arguments : none
4319
4320 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4321 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4322 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4323 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4324 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4325 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4326 logged.
4327
4328 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4329 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4330 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004332 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004333 logging.
4334
4335
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004336option dontlognull
4337no option dontlognull
4338 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4340 yes | yes | yes | no
4341 Arguments : none
4342
4343 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4344 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4345 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4346 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4347 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4348 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004349 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4350 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4351 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004352
4353 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4354 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4355 would not be logged.
4356
4357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4359
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004360 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4361 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004362
4363
4364option forceclose
4365no option forceclose
4366 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004368 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004369 Arguments : none
4370
4371 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4372 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4373 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4374 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4375 global session times in the logs.
4376
4377 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004378 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004379 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004380
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004381 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4382 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4383 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4384
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004385 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4386 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004387
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4390
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004391 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004392
4393
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004394option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004395 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | yes | yes | yes
4398 Arguments :
4399 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4400 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004401 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004402 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004403
4404 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4405 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4406 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4407 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4408 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4409 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4410 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004411 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4412 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4413 possible that the client has already brought one.
4414
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004415 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004416 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004417 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4418 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004419 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4420 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004421
4422 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4423 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4424 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4425 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4426 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4427 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4428 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4429
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004430 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4431 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4432 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4433 are under the control of the end-user.
4434
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004435 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004436 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4437 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004438 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4439 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4440 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004441
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004442 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004443 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4444 frontend www
4445 mode http
4446 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4447
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004448 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4449 backend www
4450 mode http
4451 option forwardfor header X-Client
4452
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004453 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004454 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004455
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004456
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004457option http-buffer-request
4458no option http-buffer-request
4459 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
4460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4461 yes | yes | yes | yes
4462 Arguments : none
4463
4464 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
4465 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
4466 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
4467 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
4468 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
4469 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
4470 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
4471 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
4472 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
4473 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
4474 default.
4475
4476 See also : "option http-no-delay"
4477
4478
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004479option http-ignore-probes
4480no option http-ignore-probes
4481 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
4482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4483 yes | yes | yes | no
4484 Arguments : none
4485
4486 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
4487 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
4488 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
4489 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
4490 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
4491 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
4492 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
4493 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
4494 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
4495 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
4496 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
4497 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
4498
4499 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
4500 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
4501 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
4502 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
4503 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
4504 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
4505 are often the only way to detect them.
4506
4507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4509
4510 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
4511
4512
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004513option http-keep-alive
4514no option http-keep-alive
4515 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4517 yes | yes | yes | yes
4518 Arguments : none
4519
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004520 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4521 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4522 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4523 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4524 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4525 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4526 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4527
4528 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4529 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004530 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4531 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4532 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4533 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4534 situations where this option may be useful :
4535
4536 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4537 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4538
4539 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4540 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4541
4542 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4543 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4544 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4545 request.
4546
4547 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4548 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004549 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4550 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4551 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004552
4553 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4554 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4555
4556 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4557 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4558 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4559 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4560 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4561 not set.
4562
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004563 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4564 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004565 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004566 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004567
4568 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004569 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4570 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004571
4572
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004573option http-no-delay
4574no option http-no-delay
4575 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4577 yes | yes | yes | yes
4578 Arguments : none
4579
4580 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4581 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4582 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4583 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4584 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4585 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4586 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4587 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4588 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4589 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4590 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4591 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4592 affected.
4593
4594 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4595 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4596 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4597 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4598 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4599 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4600 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4601 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4602 latency environments.
4603
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004604 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
4605
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004606
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004607option http-pretend-keepalive
4608no option http-pretend-keepalive
4609 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | yes | yes | yes
4612 Arguments : none
4613
4614 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4615 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4616 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4617 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4618 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4619 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4620 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4621 consider the response complete.
4622
4623 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4624 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4625 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4626 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4627 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4628 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4629
4630 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4631 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4632 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4633 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4634 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4635 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4636 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4637
4638 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4639 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004640 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004641 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4642 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004643
4644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4646
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004647 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4648 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004649
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004650
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004651option http-server-close
4652no option http-server-close
4653 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | yes | yes | yes
4656 Arguments : none
4657
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004658 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4659 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4660 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4661 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4662 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4663 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4664 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4665 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4666 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4667 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4668 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4669 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4670 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4671 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4672 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4673 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004674
4675 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4676 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4677 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4678 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004679 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4680 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004681
4682 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4683 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004684 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4685 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004686 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4687 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004688
4689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4691
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004692 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004693 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4694 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004695
4696
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004697option http-tunnel
4698no option http-tunnel
4699 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 yes | yes | yes | yes
4702 Arguments : none
4703
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004704 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4705 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4706 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4707 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4708 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4709 "option http-tunnel".
4710
4711 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004712 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004713 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4714 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4715 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4716 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4717 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4718 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4719 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004720
4721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4723
4724 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4725 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4726 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4727
4728
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004729option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004730no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004731 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4733 yes | yes | yes | no
4734 Arguments : none
4735
4736 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4737 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4738 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4739 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4740 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4741 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4742 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4743
4744 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4745 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4746 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4747 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4748 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4749 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4750 request along its whole life.
4751
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004752 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4753 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4754 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4755 front of an existing proxy.
4756
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004757 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4758
4759 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4760 http-server-close".
4761
4762
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004763option httpchk
4764option httpchk <uri>
4765option httpchk <method> <uri>
4766option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4767 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4769 yes | no | yes | yes
4770 Arguments :
4771 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4772 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4773 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4774 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4775 ones.
4776
4777 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4778 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4779 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4780
4781 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4782 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4783 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4784 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4785 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4786
4787 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4788 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4789 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4790 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4791 the lack of any response.
4792
4793 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4794
4795 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4796 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4797 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4798
4799 Examples :
4800 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4801 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4802 backend https_relay
4803 mode tcp
4804 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4805 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4806
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004807 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4808 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4809 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004810
4811
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004812option httpclose
4813no option httpclose
4814 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 yes | yes | yes | yes
4817 Arguments : none
4818
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004819 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4820 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4821 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4822 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004823 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004824 "option http-tunnel".
4825
4826 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4827 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4828 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4829 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4830 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4831 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4832 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4833 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004834
4835 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004836 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004837 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4838 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4839 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4840 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4841 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004842
4843 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4844 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004845 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4846 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004847 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4848 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004849
4850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4852
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004853 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4854 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004855
4856
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004857option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004858 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4860 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004861 Arguments :
4862 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4863 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4864 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4865 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4866 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004867
4868 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4869 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4870 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4871 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4872 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4873 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4874 ports.
4875
4876 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4877
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004878 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4879 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004881 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004882
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004883
4884option http_proxy
4885no option http_proxy
4886 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | yes | yes | yes
4889 Arguments : none
4890
4891 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4892 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4893 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4894 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4895 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4896
4897 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4898 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4899 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4900 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004901 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004902 be analyzed.
4903
4904 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4905 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4906
4907 Example :
4908 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4909 backend direct_forward
4910 option httpclose
4911 option http_proxy
4912
4913 See also : "option httpclose"
4914
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004915
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004916option independent-streams
4917no option independent-streams
4918 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | yes
4921 Arguments : none
4922
4923 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4924 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4925 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4926 receive data or not.
4927
4928 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4929 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4930 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4931 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4932 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4933 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4934 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4935 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4936 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4937 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4938 socket buffers.
4939
4940 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4941 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4942 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4943 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4944 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4945
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004946 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004947 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4948 deprecated.
4949
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004950 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004951
4952
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004953option ldap-check
4954 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4956 yes | no | yes | yes
4957 Arguments : none
4958
4959 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4960 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4961 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4962 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4963
4964 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4965 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4966
4967 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4968 configure it.
4969
4970 Example :
4971 option ldap-check
4972
4973 See also : "option httpchk"
4974
4975
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004976option external-check
4977 Use external processes for server health checks
4978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4979 yes | no | yes | yes
4980
4981 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4982 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4983 command".
4984
4985 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4986
4987 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4988
4989
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004990option log-health-checks
4991no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004992 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | no | yes | yes
4995 Arguments : none
4996
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004997 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4998 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4999 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005000
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005001 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5002 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5003 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5004 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5005 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5006
5007 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5008 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005009
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005010 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5011 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5012 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005013
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005014
5015option log-separate-errors
5016no option log-separate-errors
5017 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5019 yes | yes | yes | no
5020 Arguments : none
5021
5022 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5023 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5024 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5025 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5026 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5027 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5028 provides very important information.
5029
5030 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5031 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5032 error logs.
5033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005034 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005035 logging.
5036
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005037
5038option logasap
5039no option logasap
5040 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | yes | yes | no
5043 Arguments : none
5044
5045 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5046 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5047 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5048 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5049 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5050 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5051 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005052 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005053 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5054 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5055
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005056 Examples :
5057 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5058 mode http
5059 option httplog
5060 option logasap
5061 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5062
5063 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5064 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5065 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5066 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005068 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005069 logging.
5070
5071
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005072option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005073 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005076 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005077 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5078 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005079 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005080
5081 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5082 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5083 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5084 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5085 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5086 in the MySQL table, like this :
5087
5088 USE mysql;
5089 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5090 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5091
5092 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5093 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5094 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5095 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5096 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5097 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5098 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5099 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5100 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5101
5102 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5103 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005104
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005105 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005106
5107 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5108 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5109 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5110 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5111 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
5112 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
5113
5114 See also: "option httpchk"
5115
5116
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005117option nolinger
5118no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005119 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5121 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005122 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005123
5124 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5125 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5126 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5127 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5128 connections.
5129
5130 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5131 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5132 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5133 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5134 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5135 this too.
5136
5137 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5138 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5139 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5140
5141 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5142 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5143 for servers.
5144
5145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5147
5148
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005149option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5150 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5152 yes | yes | yes | yes
5153 Arguments :
5154 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5155 matching <network>
5156 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5157 header name.
5158
5159 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5160 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5161 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5162 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5163 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5164 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5165 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5166 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5167 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5168 possible that the client has already brought one.
5169
5170 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5171 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5172 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5173 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5174 header and requires different one.
5175
5176 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5177 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5178 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5179 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5180 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5181 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5182 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5183
5184 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5185 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5186 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5187 both are defined.
5188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005189 Examples :
5190 # Original Destination address
5191 frontend www
5192 mode http
5193 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5194
5195 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5196 backend www
5197 mode http
5198 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5199
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005200 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5201 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005202
5203
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005204option persist
5205no option persist
5206 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5208 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005209 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005210
5211 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5212 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5213 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5214 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5215 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5216 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5217 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5218 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5219 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5220 redirected to another valid server.
5221
5222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5224
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005225 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005226
5227
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005228option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5229 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5231 yes | no | yes | yes
5232 Arguments :
5233 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5234 PostgreSQL server.
5235
5236 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5237 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5238 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5239 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5240
5241 See also: "option httpchk"
5242
5243
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005244option prefer-last-server
5245no option prefer-last-server
5246 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5247 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 yes | no | yes | yes
5249 Arguments : none
5250
5251 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5252 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5253 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5254 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5255 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5256 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5257 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5258 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5259 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005260 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5261 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5262 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5263 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5264 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5265 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5266 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005267
5268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5270
5271 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5272
5273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005274option redispatch
5275no option redispatch
5276 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005279 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005280
5281 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5282 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5283 be able to access the service anymore.
5284
5285 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5286 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5287
5288 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5289 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5290 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005292 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5293 "redisp" keywords.
5294
5295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5297
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005298 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005299
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005300
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005301option redis-check
5302 Use redis health checks for server testing
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | no | yes | yes
5305 Arguments : none
5306
5307 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5308 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5309 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5310 find the "+PONG" response message.
5311
5312 Example :
5313 option redis-check
5314
5315 See also : "option httpchk"
5316
5317
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005318option smtpchk
5319option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5320 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005323 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005324 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5325 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5326 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5327
5328 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5329 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5330 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5331
5332 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5333 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5334 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5335 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5336 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5337 dead server.
5338
5339 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5340 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5341 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5342 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5343
5344 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5345 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5346 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5347 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5348 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5349
5350 Example :
5351 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5352
5353 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5354
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005356option socket-stats
5357no option socket-stats
5358
5359 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5361 yes | yes | yes | no
5362
5363 Arguments : none
5364
5365
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005366option splice-auto
5367no option splice-auto
5368 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5370 yes | yes | yes | yes
5371 Arguments : none
5372
5373 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5374 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5375 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5376 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005377 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005378 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5379 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5380 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5381 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5382
5383 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5384 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5385 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5386 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5387 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5388 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5389 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5390 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5391 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5392 keyword.
5393
5394 Example :
5395 option splice-auto
5396
5397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5399
5400 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5401 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5402
5403
5404option splice-request
5405no option splice-request
5406 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5408 yes | yes | yes | yes
5409 Arguments : none
5410
5411 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005412 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005413 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5414 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5415 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5416 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5417
5418 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5419
5420 Example :
5421 option splice-request
5422
5423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5425
5426 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5427 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5428
5429
5430option splice-response
5431no option splice-response
5432 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5434 yes | yes | yes | yes
5435 Arguments : none
5436
5437 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005438 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005439 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5440 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5441 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5442 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5443
5444 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5445
5446 Example :
5447 option splice-response
5448
5449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5451
5452 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5453 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5454
5455
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005456option srvtcpka
5457no option srvtcpka
5458 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461 Arguments : none
5462
5463 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5464 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5465 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5466 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5467
5468 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5469 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5470 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5471 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5472
5473 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5474 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5475 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5476 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5477 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5478
5479 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5480
5481 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5482 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5483 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5484
5485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5487
5488 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5489
5490
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005491option ssl-hello-chk
5492 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | no | yes | yes
5495 Arguments : none
5496
5497 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5498 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5499 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5500 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5501 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5502 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5503 hello message.
5504
5505 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5506 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5507 messages, which is appreciable.
5508
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005509 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5510 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5511 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005512
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005513 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5514
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005515
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005516option tcp-check
5517 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5518 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5519 yes | no | yes | yes
5520
5521 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5522 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5523
5524 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5525 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5526 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5527
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005528 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005529 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5530 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5531 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5532 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5533 only.
5534
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005535 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005536 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5537 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5538 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5539 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5540
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005541 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005542 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5543 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005544 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005545 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5546 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5547 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5548 the respective protocols.
5549 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5550 analysed.
5551
5552 Examples :
5553 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5554 option tcp-check
5555 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5556
5557 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5558 option tcp-check
5559 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5560
5561 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5562 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005563 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005564 option tcp-check
5565 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5566 tcp-check expect +PONG
5567 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5568 tcp-check expect string role:master
5569 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5570 tcp-check expect string +OK
5571
5572 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5573 (send many headers before analyzing)
5574 option tcp-check
5575 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5576 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5577 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5578 tcp-check send \r\n
5579 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5580
5581
5582 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5583
5584
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005585option tcp-smart-accept
5586no option tcp-smart-accept
5587 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 yes | yes | yes | no
5590 Arguments : none
5591
5592 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5593 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5594 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5595 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5596 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5597 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5598
5599 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5600 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5601 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5602 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5603
5604 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5605 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5606 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5607 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5608
5609 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5610 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5611 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5612
5613 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5614 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5615 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5616
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005617 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5618
5619
5620option tcp-smart-connect
5621no option tcp-smart-connect
5622 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | no | yes | yes
5625 Arguments : none
5626
5627 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5628 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5629 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5630 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5631 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5632
5633 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5634 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5635 complex.
5636
5637 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5638 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5639 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5640
5641 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5642 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5643
5644 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5645
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005646
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005647option tcpka
5648 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5650 yes | yes | yes | yes
5651 Arguments : none
5652
5653 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5654 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5655 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5656 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5657
5658 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5659 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5660 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5661 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5662
5663 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5664 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5665 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5666 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5667 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5668
5669 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5670
5671 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5672 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5673 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5674 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5675 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5676 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5677 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5678 backends.
5679
5680 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5681
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005682
5683option tcplog
5684 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5686 yes | yes | yes | yes
5687 Arguments : none
5688
5689 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5690 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5691 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5692 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5693 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5694 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5695 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5696 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5697
5698 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005700 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005701
5702
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005703option transparent
5704no option transparent
5705 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005707 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005708 Arguments : none
5709
5710 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5711 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5712 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5713 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5714 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5715 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5716 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5717 appropriate server.
5718
5719 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5720 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5721
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005722 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005723 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005724
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005725
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005726external-check command <command>
5727 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5729 yes | no | yes | yes
5730
5731 Arguments :
5732 <command> is the external command to run
5733
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005734 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5735
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005736 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005737
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005738 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5739 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5740 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5741 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5742 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5743 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005744
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005745 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5746
5747 Environment variables :
5748 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5749 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5750
5751 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5752
5753 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5754
5755 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5756 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5757 for a UNIX socket).
5758
5759 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5760
5761 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5762
5763 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5764
5765 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5766
5767 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5768
5769 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5770 socket).
5771
5772 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5773 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5774
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005775 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5776 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5777 failed.
5778
5779 Example :
5780 external-check command /bin/true
5781
5782 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5783
5784
5785external-check path <path>
5786 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | no | yes | yes
5789
5790 Arguments :
5791 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5792
5793 The default path is "".
5794
5795 Example :
5796 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5797
5798 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5799 "external-check command"
5800
5801
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005802persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005803persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005804 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5806 yes | no | yes | yes
5807 Arguments :
5808 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005809 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5810 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005811
5812 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5813 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5814 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5815 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5816 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5817 forwarded to this server.
5818
5819 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5820 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5821 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005822 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005823 a single "listen" section.
5824
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005825 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5826 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5827 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5828
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005829 Example :
5830 listen tse-farm
5831 bind :3389
5832 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5833 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5834 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5835 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5836 persist rdp-cookie
5837 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005838 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005839 balance rdp-cookie
5840 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5841 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5842
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005843 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5844 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005845
5846
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005847rate-limit sessions <rate>
5848 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5850 yes | yes | yes | no
5851 Arguments :
5852 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5853 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5854
5855 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5856 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5857 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5858 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5859 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5860 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5861
5862 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5863 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5864 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5865 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5866
5867 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5868 listen smtp
5869 mode tcp
5870 bind :25
5871 rate-limit sessions 10
5872 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5873
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005874 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5875 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5876 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005877
5878 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5879
5880
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005881redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5882redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5883redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005884 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5886 no | yes | yes | yes
5887
5888 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005889 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005890
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005891 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005892 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005893 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5894 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5895 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005896
5897 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5898 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5899 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5900 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5901 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005902 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5903 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5904 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5905 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005906
5907 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5908 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5909 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5910 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5911 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5912 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005913 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005914 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005915 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5916 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5917 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005918
5919 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005920 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5921 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5922 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5923 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5924 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5925 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5926 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5927 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005928
5929 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5930 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5931
5932 - "drop-query"
5933 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5934 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5935 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5936 with a location-type redirect.
5937
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005938 - "append-slash"
5939 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5940 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5941 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5942 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5943
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005944 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5945 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5946 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5947 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5948 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5949 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5950 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5951
5952 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5953 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5954 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5955 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5956 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5957 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5958 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005959
5960 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5961 acl clear dst_port 80
5962 acl secure dst_port 8080
5963 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005964 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005965 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005966 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5967
5968 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005969 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5970 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5971 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005972 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005973
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005974 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5975 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5976 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5977
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005978 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005979 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005980
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005981 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5982 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5983 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005985 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005986
5987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005988redisp (deprecated)
5989redispatch (deprecated)
5990 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5992 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005993 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005994
5995 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5996 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5997 be able to access the service anymore.
5998
5999 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6000 redistribute them to a working server.
6001
6002 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6003 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6004 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006006 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6007 "option redispatch" instead.
6008
6009 See also : "option redispatch"
6010
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006011
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006012reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006013 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6015 no | yes | yes | yes
6016 Arguments :
6017 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6018 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006019 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006020
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006021 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6022 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6023
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006024 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6025 the last header of an HTTP request.
6026
6027 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6028 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6029 responses.
6030
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006031 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6032 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6033 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6034
6035 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6036 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006037
6038
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006039reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6040reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006041 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6043 no | yes | yes | yes
6044 Arguments :
6045 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6046 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6047 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6048 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6049 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6050 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6051 ignores case.
6052
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006053 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6054 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6055
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006056 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6057 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6058 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6059 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006060 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006061
6062 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6063 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6064
6065 Example :
6066 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6067 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6068 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6069
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006070 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6071 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006072
6073
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006074reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6075reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006076 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6078 no | yes | yes | yes
6079 Arguments :
6080 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6081 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6082 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6083 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6084 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6085 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6086
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006087 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6088 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6089
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006090 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6091 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6092 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6093 next servers.
6094
6095 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6096 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6097 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6098
6099 Example :
6100 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6101 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6102 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6103
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006104 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6105 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006106
6107
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006108reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6109reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006110 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6112 no | yes | yes | yes
6113 Arguments :
6114 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6115 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6116 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6117 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6118 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6119 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6120 case.
6121
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006122 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6123 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6124
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006125 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6126 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6127 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6128 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006129 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006130
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006131 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006132 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006133 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006134
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006135 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6136 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6137
6138 Example :
6139 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6140 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6141 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6142
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006143 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6144 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006145
6146
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006147reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6148reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006149 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6151 no | yes | yes | yes
6152 Arguments :
6153 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6154 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6155 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6156 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6157 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6158 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6159 case.
6160
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006161 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6162 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6163
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006164 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6165 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6166 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6167 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6168
6169 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6170 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6171
6172 Example :
6173 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6174 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6175 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6176 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6177
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006178 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6179 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006180
6181
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006182reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6183reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006184 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 no | yes | yes | yes
6187 Arguments :
6188 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6189 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6190 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6191 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6192 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6193 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6194
6195 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6196 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6197 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6198 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006199 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006200
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006201 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6202 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6203
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006204 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6205 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6206 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6207
6208 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6209 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6210 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6211 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6212 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6213
6214 Example :
6215 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006216 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006217 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6218 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6219
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006220 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6221 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006222
6223
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006224reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6225reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006226 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 no | yes | yes | yes
6229 Arguments :
6230 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6231 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6232 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6233 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6234 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6235 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6236 ignores case.
6237
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006238 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6239 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6240
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006241 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6242 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006243 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6244 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6245 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006246 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6247 not set.
6248
6249 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6250 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6251 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6252 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6253 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6254
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006255 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006256 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6257 # block all others.
6258 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6259 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6260
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006261 # block bad guys
6262 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6263 reqitarpit . if badguys
6264
6265 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6266 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006267
6268
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006269retries <value>
6270 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6272 yes | no | yes | yes
6273 Arguments :
6274 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6275 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6276 default value is 3.
6277
6278 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6279 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6280 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6281
6282 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6283 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6284
6285 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6286 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6287
6288 See also : "option redispatch"
6289
6290
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006291rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006292 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6294 no | yes | yes | yes
6295 Arguments :
6296 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6297 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006298 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006299
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006300 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6301 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6302
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006303 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6304 the last header of an HTTP response.
6305
6306 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6307 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6308 responses.
6309
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006310 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6311 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006312
6313
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006314rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6315rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006316 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6318 no | yes | yes | yes
6319 Arguments :
6320 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6321 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6322 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6323 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6324 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6325 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6326 ignores case.
6327
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006328 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6329 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6330
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006331 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6332 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006333 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006334 client.
6335
6336 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6337 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6338 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6339
6340 Example :
6341 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006342 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006343
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006344 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6345 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006346
6347
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006348rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6349rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006350 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 no | yes | yes | yes
6353 Arguments :
6354 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6355 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6356 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6357 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6358 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6359 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6360 ignores case.
6361
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006362 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6363 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6364
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006365 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6366 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6367 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6368 case-sensitive.
6369
6370 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006371 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6372 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6373 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006374
6375 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6376 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6377
6378 Example :
6379 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6380 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6381
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006382 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6383 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006384
6385
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006386rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6387rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006388 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6390 no | yes | yes | yes
6391 Arguments :
6392 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6393 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6394 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6395 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6396 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6397 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6398 ignores case.
6399
6400 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6401 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6402 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6403 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006404 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006405
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006406 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6407 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6408
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006409 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6410 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6411 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6412
6413 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6414 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6415 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6416 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6417 are not case-sensitive.
6418
6419 Example :
6420 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6421 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6422
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006423 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6424 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006425
6426
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006427server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006428 Declare a server in a backend
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 no | no | yes | yes
6431 Arguments :
6432 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006433 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006434 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006435
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006436 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6437 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6438 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6439 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006440 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6441 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6442 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6443 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6444 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006445 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6446 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6447 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6448 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6449 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6450 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6451 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006452 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006453 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6454 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6455 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6456 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006457
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006458 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006459 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6460 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6461 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6462 adding this value to the client's port.
6463
6464 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6465 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006466 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006467
6468 Examples :
6469 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6470 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006471 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006472 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6473 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6474 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006475
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006476 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6477 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006478
6479
6480source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006481source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006482source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006483 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 yes | no | yes | yes
6486 Arguments :
6487 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6488 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006489
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006490 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006491 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6492 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6493 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6494 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6495 supported prefixes are :
6496 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6497 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6498 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006499 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006500 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6501 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6502 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6503 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006504
6505 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6506 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006507 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6508 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6509 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006510
6511 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6512 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6513 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6514 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6515 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6516 <addr>.
6517
6518 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6519 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6520 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6521 port.
6522
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006523 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6524 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6525 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6526 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006527 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006528 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6529 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6530 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6531 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6532 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6533 HTTP header.
6534
6535 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6536 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006537 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006538 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6539 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6540 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6541 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6542 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6543 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6544 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6545
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006546 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6547 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6548 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6549 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6550 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6551 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6552
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006553 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6554 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6555 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6556 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6557
6558 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6559 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6560 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6561 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6562 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6563 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6564
6565 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6566 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6567 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6568 there are two methods :
6569
6570 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6571 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6572 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6573 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6574 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6575 of the client ranges may be used.
6576
6577 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6578 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6579 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6580 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6581 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6582 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6583 same session.
6584
6585 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6586 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6587 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6588 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6589 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6590 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6591
6592 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6593 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6594 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006595 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006596
6597 Examples :
6598 backend private
6599 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6600 source 192.168.1.200
6601
6602 backend transparent_ssl1
6603 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6604 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6605
6606 backend transparent_ssl2
6607 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6608 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6609 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6610
6611 backend transparent_ssl3
6612 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6613 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6614 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6615
6616 backend transparent_smtp
6617 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6618 # with Tproxy version 4.
6619 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6620
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006621 backend transparent_http
6622 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6623 # proxy.
6624 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006626 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006627 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006629
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006630srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6631 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 yes | no | yes | yes
6634 Arguments :
6635 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6636 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6637 as explained at the top of this document.
6638
6639 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6640 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6641 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6642 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6643 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6644 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6645 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6646
6647 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6648 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6649 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6650 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6651 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006652 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006653 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006654 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006655
6656 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6657 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6658 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6659 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6660 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6661 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6662
6663 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6664 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6665
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006666 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6667 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006668
6669
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006670stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6671 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006673 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006674
6675 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6676 matched.
6677
6678 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6679 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6680
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006681 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6682 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6683 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6684
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006685 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6686 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6687 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6688 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006689
6690 Example :
6691 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6692 backend stats_localhost
6693 stats enable
6694 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6695
6696 Example :
6697 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6698 backend stats_auth
6699 stats enable
6700 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6701 stats admin if TRUE
6702
6703 Example :
6704 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6705 userlist stats-auth
6706 group admin users admin
6707 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6708 group readonly users haproxy
6709 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6710
6711 backend stats_auth
6712 stats enable
6713 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6714 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6715 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6716 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6717
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006718 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6719 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6720 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006721
6722
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006723stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6724 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006726 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006727 Arguments :
6728 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6729
6730 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6731
6732 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6733 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6734 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6735 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6736 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6737 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6738
6739 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6740 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6741 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006742 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006743
6744 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6745 report using "stats scope".
6746
6747 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6748 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6749 unobvious parameters.
6750
6751 Example :
6752 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6753 backend public_www
6754 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6755 stats enable
6756 stats hide-version
6757 stats scope .
6758 stats uri /admin?stats
6759 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6760 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6761 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6762
6763 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6764 backend private_monitoring
6765 stats enable
6766 stats uri /admin?stats
6767 stats refresh 5s
6768
6769 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6770
6771
6772stats enable
6773 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006775 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006776 Arguments : none
6777
6778 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6779 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6780 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6781 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6782 - stats auth : no authentication
6783 - stats scope : no restriction
6784
6785 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6786 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6787 unobvious parameters.
6788
6789 Example :
6790 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6791 backend public_www
6792 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6793 stats enable
6794 stats hide-version
6795 stats scope .
6796 stats uri /admin?stats
6797 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6798 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6799 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6800
6801 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6802 backend private_monitoring
6803 stats enable
6804 stats uri /admin?stats
6805 stats refresh 5s
6806
6807 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6808
6809
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006810stats hide-version
6811 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006813 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006814 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006816 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6817 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6818 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6819 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6820 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6821 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006822
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006823 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6824 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6825 unobvious parameters.
6826
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006827 Example :
6828 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6829 backend public_www
6830 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006831 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006832 stats hide-version
6833 stats scope .
6834 stats uri /admin?stats
6835 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6836 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6837 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006838
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006839 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6840 backend private_monitoring
6841 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006842 stats uri /admin?stats
6843 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006844
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006845 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006846
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006847
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006848stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6849 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6850 Access control for statistics
6851
6852 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6853 no | no | yes | yes
6854
6855 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6856 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6857 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6858 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6859 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6860 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6861
6862 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6863 instance.
6864
6865 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6866 about ACL usage.
6867
6868
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006869stats realm <realm>
6870 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006872 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006873 Arguments :
6874 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6875 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6876 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6877
6878 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6879 using a backslash ('\').
6880
6881 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6882 only related to authentication.
6883
6884 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6885 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6886 unobvious parameters.
6887
6888 Example :
6889 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6890 backend public_www
6891 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6892 stats enable
6893 stats hide-version
6894 stats scope .
6895 stats uri /admin?stats
6896 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6897 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6898 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6899
6900 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6901 backend private_monitoring
6902 stats enable
6903 stats uri /admin?stats
6904 stats refresh 5s
6905
6906 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6907
6908
6909stats refresh <delay>
6910 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006912 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006913 Arguments :
6914 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6915 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6916 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6917 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6918 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6919 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6920
6921 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6922 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6923 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6924 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6925
6926 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6927 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6928 unobvious parameters.
6929
6930 Example :
6931 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6932 backend public_www
6933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6934 stats enable
6935 stats hide-version
6936 stats scope .
6937 stats uri /admin?stats
6938 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6939 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6940 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6941
6942 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6943 backend private_monitoring
6944 stats enable
6945 stats uri /admin?stats
6946 stats refresh 5s
6947
6948 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6949
6950
6951stats scope { <name> | "." }
6952 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006954 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006955 Arguments :
6956 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6957 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6958 section in which the statement appears.
6959
6960 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6961 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6962 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6963 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6964 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6965 exists.
6966
6967 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6968 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6969 unobvious parameters.
6970
6971 Example :
6972 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6973 backend public_www
6974 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6975 stats enable
6976 stats hide-version
6977 stats scope .
6978 stats uri /admin?stats
6979 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6980 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6981 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6982
6983 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6984 backend private_monitoring
6985 stats enable
6986 stats uri /admin?stats
6987 stats refresh 5s
6988
6989 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6990
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006991
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006992stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006993 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006995 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006996
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006997 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006998 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6999
7000 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7001 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7002
7003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007005 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007006
7007 Example :
7008 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7009 backend private_monitoring
7010 stats enable
7011 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7012 stats uri /admin?stats
7013 stats refresh 5s
7014
7015 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7016 global section.
7017
7018
7019stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007020 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7022 yes | yes | yes | yes
7023 Arguments : none
7024
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007025 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007026 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7027 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7028 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7029 - IP (socket, server)
7030 - cookie (backend, server)
7031
7032 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7033 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007034 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007035
7036 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7037
7038
7039stats show-node [ <name> ]
7040 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007042 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007043 Arguments:
7044 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7045 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7046
7047 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7048 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007049 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007050
7051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7053 unobvious parameters.
7054
7055 Example:
7056 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7057 backend private_monitoring
7058 stats enable
7059 stats show-node Europe-1
7060 stats uri /admin?stats
7061 stats refresh 5s
7062
7063 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7064 section.
7065
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007066
7067stats uri <prefix>
7068 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007070 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007071 Arguments :
7072 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7073 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7074 query string.
7075
7076 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7077 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7078 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7079 possible to reach it in the application.
7080
7081 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007082 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007083 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7084 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7085 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7086 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7087
7088 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7089 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7090 an address or a port to statistics only.
7091
7092 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7093 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7094 unobvious parameters.
7095
7096 Example :
7097 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7098 backend public_www
7099 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7100 stats enable
7101 stats hide-version
7102 stats scope .
7103 stats uri /admin?stats
7104 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7105 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7106 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7107
7108 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7109 backend private_monitoring
7110 stats enable
7111 stats uri /admin?stats
7112 stats refresh 5s
7113
7114 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7115
7116
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007117stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7118 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007120 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007121
7122 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007123 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007124 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7125 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7126 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7127
7128 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7129 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7130 the "stick-table" statement.
7131
7132 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7133 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7134 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7135 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7136 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7137
7138 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7139 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7140 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7141 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7142 transformation rules.
7143
7144 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7145 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7146 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7147 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7148 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7149 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7150 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7151
7152 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7153 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7154 ACL based conditions.
7155
7156 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7157 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7158 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7159 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7160
7161 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7162 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7163 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7164 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7165
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007166 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7167 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7168 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7169
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007170 Example :
7171 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7172 # last 30 minutes
7173 backend pop
7174 mode tcp
7175 balance roundrobin
7176 stick store-request src
7177 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7178 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7179 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7180
7181 backend smtp
7182 mode tcp
7183 balance roundrobin
7184 stick match src table pop
7185 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7186 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7187
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007188 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007189 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007190
7191
7192stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7193 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7195 no | no | yes | yes
7196
7197 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7198 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7199 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7200 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7201
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007202 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7203 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7204 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7205
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007206 Examples :
7207 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007208 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007209
7210 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7211 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7212 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7213
7214
7215 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7216 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7217 backend http
7218 mode http
7219 balance roundrobin
7220 stick on src table https
7221 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7222 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7223 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7224
7225 backend https
7226 mode tcp
7227 balance roundrobin
7228 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7229 stick on src
7230 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7231 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7232
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007233 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007234
7235
7236stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7237 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 no | no | yes | yes
7240
7241 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007242 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007243 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7244 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7245 server is selected.
7246
7247 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7248 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7249 the "stick-table" statement.
7250
7251 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7252 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7253 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7254 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7255 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7256 address.
7257
7258 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7259 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7260 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7261 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7262 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7263 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7264 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7265 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7266 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7267 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7268
7269 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7270 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7271 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7272 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7273 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7274 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7275 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7276
7277 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7278 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7279 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7280 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7281
7282 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7283 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7284 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7285 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7286 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7287 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007288 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7289 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7290 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7291 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7292 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7293 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007294
7295 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7296 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7297 the request.
7298
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007299 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7300 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7301 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7302
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007303 Example :
7304 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7305 # last 30 minutes
7306 backend pop
7307 mode tcp
7308 balance roundrobin
7309 stick store-request src
7310 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7311 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7312 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7313
7314 backend smtp
7315 mode tcp
7316 balance roundrobin
7317 stick match src table pop
7318 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7319 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7320
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007321 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007322 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007323
7324
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007325stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007326 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7327 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007328 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007330 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007331
7332 Arguments :
7333 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7334 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7335 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7336 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7337
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007338 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7339 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7340 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7341 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7342
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007343 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7344 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7345 instance.
7346
7347 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7348 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7349 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7350 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7351 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7352 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007353 to 32 characters.
7354
7355 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7356 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7357 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007358 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007359 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7360 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007361
7362 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007363 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7364 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007365 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7366 increase.
7367
7368 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007369 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7370 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7371 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007372
7373 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7374 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7375 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7376 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7377 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7378 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7379 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7380 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7381 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7382 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7383 parameter (see below).
7384
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007385 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7386 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7387 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7388 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7389 soft restart.
7390
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02007391 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
7392 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007393
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007394 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7395 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7396 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7397 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7398 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007399 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007400 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7401 if not expiration delay is specified.
7402
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007403 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7404 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7405 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7406 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007407 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7408 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7409 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7410 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7411 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7412 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7413 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7414 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7415 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7416 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7417 types and their arguments.
7418
7419 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7420 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7421 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7422 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7423
7424 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7425 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7426 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7427 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7428
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007429 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7430 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7431 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7432 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7433 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7434 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7435
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007436 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7437 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7438 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7439 they were received.
7440
7441 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7442 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7443 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7444 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7445 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7446
7447 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7448 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7449 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7450 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7451 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7452
7453 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7454 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7455 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7456
7457 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7458 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7459 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7460 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7461 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7462
7463 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7464 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7465 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7466 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7467 the client side.
7468
7469 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7470 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7471 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7472 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7473 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7474 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7475 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7476
7477 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7478 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7479 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7480 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7481 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7482 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7483 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7484
7485 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7486 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7487 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7488 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7489 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7490 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7491
7492 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7493 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7494 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7495 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7496
7497 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7498 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7499 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7500 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7501 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7502 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7503 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7504 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7505 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7506 recommended for better fairness.
7507
7508 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7509 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7510 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7511 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7512
7513 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7514 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7515 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7516 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7517 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7518 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7519 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7520 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7521 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7522 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007523
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007524 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7525 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007526 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7527 reference it.
7528
7529 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7530 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7531 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7532 as an exclusive stickiness.
7533
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007534 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7535 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7536 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7537 something that can be ignored.
7538
7539 Example:
7540 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7541 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7542 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7543 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7544
7545 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007546 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007547
7548
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007549stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7550 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7552 no | no | yes | yes
7553
7554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007555 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007556 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7557 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7558 server is selected.
7559
7560 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7561 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7562 the "stick-table" statement.
7563
7564 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7565 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7566 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7567 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7568
7569 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7570 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7571 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7572 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7573 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7574 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007575 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007576 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7577 rules.
7578
7579 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7580 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7581 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7582 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7583 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7584 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7585 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7586
7587 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7588 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7589 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7590 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7591
7592 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7593 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7594 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7595 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7596 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7597 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007598 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7599 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7600 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7601 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7602 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7603 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7604 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7605 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7606 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007607
7608 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7609
7610 Example :
7611 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7612 backend https
7613 mode tcp
7614 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007615 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007616 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007617
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007618 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7619 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7620
7621 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7622 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7623 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7624
7625 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7626 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007627
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007628 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7629 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7630 # at offset 44.
7631
7632 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7633 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7634
7635 # Learn on response if server hello.
7636 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007637
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007638 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7639 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7640
7641 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7642 extraction.
7643
7644
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007645tcp-check connect [params*]
7646 Opens a new connection
7647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7648 no | no | yes | yes
7649
7650 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7651 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7652 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7653
7654 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7655 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7656 of the sequence.
7657
7658 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7659 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7660 do.
7661
7662 Parameters :
7663 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7664 use the TCP connection.
7665
7666 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7667 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7668 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7669
7670 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7671
7672 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7673
7674 Examples:
7675 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7676 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7677 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7678 option tcp-check
7679 tcp-check connect
7680 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7681 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7682 tcp-check send \r\n
7683 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7684 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7685 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7686 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7687 tcp-check send \r\n
7688 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7689 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7690
7691 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7692 option tcp-check
7693 tcp-check connect port 110
7694 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7695 tcp-check connect port 143
7696 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7697 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7698
7699 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7700
7701
7702tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7703 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7705 no | no | yes | yes
7706
7707 Arguments :
7708 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7709 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7710 binary.
7711 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7712 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7713 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7714
7715 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7716 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7717 with the usual backslash ('\').
7718 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7719 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7720 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7721 used upper or lower case.
7722
7723
7724 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7725
7726 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7727 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7728 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7729 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7730 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7731 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7732 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7733 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7734
7735 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7736 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7737 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7738 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7739 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7740 expression.
7741
7742 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7743 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7744 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7745 this exact hexadecimal string.
7746 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7747
7748 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7749 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7750 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7751 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7752 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7753 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7754 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7755 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7756 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7757 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7758 the null character.
7759
7760 Examples :
7761 # perform a POP check
7762 option tcp-check
7763 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7764
7765 # perform an IMAP check
7766 option tcp-check
7767 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7768
7769 # look for the redis master server
7770 option tcp-check
7771 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7772 tcp-check expect +PONG
7773 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7774 tcp-check expect string role:master
7775 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7776 tcp-check expect string +OK
7777
7778
7779 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7780 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7781
7782
7783tcp-check send <data>
7784 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7786 no | no | yes | yes
7787
7788 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7789 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7790
7791 Examples :
7792 # look for the redis master server
7793 option tcp-check
7794 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7795 tcp-check expect string role:master
7796
7797 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7798 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7799
7800
7801tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7802 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7803 tcp health check
7804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7805 no | no | yes | yes
7806
7807 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7808 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7809 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7810 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7811 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7812 hexadecimal string.
7813 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7814
7815 Examples :
7816 # redis check in binary
7817 option tcp-check
7818 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7819 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7820
7821
7822 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7823 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7824
7825
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007826tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7827 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007830 Arguments :
7831 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007832 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7833 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007835 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007836
7837 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7838 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007839 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7840 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7841 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7842 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7843 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7844 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007845
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007846 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7847 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7848 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7849 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007850
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007851 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007852 - accept :
7853 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7854 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7855 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007857 - reject :
7858 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7859 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7860 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7861 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7862 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7863 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7864 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7865 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7866 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7867 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7868 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7869 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007870
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007871 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7872 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7873 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7874 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7875 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7876 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7877 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7878 hosts.
7879
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007880 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7881 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7882 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7883 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7884 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7885 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7886 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7887 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7888 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7889 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7890 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7891
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007892 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007893 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007894 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007895 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007896 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7897 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007898 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007899 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7900 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7901 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7902 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7903 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007904
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007905 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007906 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007907 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007908 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7909 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7910 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7911 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007912
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007913 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7914 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7915 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7916 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007917
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007918 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7919 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7920 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7921 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7922 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007923 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7924 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7925 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7926 layer7 information is extracted.
7927
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007928 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7929 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7930 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7931 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7932 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007933
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007934 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7935 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7936 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007938 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7939 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7940 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007942 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007943 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007944 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007945
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007946 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7947 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7948 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007950 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007951 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7952 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007953
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007954 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7955
7956 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7957
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007958 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007960 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007961
7962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007963tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7964 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007966 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007967 Arguments :
7968 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007969 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007970 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
7971 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007973 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007974
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007975 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7976 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7977 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7978 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7979 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007980
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007981 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7982 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7983 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7984 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007985 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7986 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7987 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7988 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7989 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7990 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007991 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007992 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007993
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007994 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7995 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7996 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7997 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007998
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007999 Four types of actions are supported :
8000 - accept : the request is accepted
8001 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8002 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008003 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008005 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8006 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008007
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008008 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8009 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8010 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8011 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8012 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8013 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008015 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008016 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8017 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008019 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008020 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8021 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8022 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8023 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008024 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8025 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8026 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008027
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008028 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008029 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8030 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8031 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008032
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008033 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8034 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8035 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8036 documentation.
8037
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008038 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008039 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8040 # and reject everything else.
8041 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8042 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008043 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008044 tcp-request content reject
8045
8046 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008047 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8048 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8049 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008050 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008051
8052 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8053 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8054 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008055 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008056 tcp-request content reject
8057
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008058 Example:
8059 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8060 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008061 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008062
8063 Example:
8064 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8065 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008066 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008068 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8069 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8070
8071 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008072 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008073 # protecting all our sites
8074 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008075 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8076 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008077 ...
8078 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8079
8080 backend http_dynamic
8081 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008082 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008083 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008084 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8085 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8086 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008087 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008089 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008091 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008092
8093
8094tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8095 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008097 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008098 Arguments :
8099 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8100 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8101 as explained at the top of this document.
8102
8103 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8104 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8105 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8106 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8107 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8108
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008109 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8110 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8111 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8112 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8113
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008114 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8115 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008116 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008117 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008118 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8119 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8120 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8121 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008122
8123 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8124 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8125 it pass through unaffected.
8126
8127 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8128 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8129 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008130 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008131 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8132 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008133 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8134 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8135 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008136
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008137 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008138 "timeout client".
8139
8140
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008141tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8142 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8144 no | no | yes | yes
8145 Arguments :
8146 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008147 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008148
8149 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8150
8151 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8152 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8153 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008154 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8155 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008156
8157 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8158
8159 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8160 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8161 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8162 inserted.
8163
8164 Two types of actions are supported :
8165 - accept :
8166 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8167 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8168 the rules evaluation.
8169
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008170 - close :
8171 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8172 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8173 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8174 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8175 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8176 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008177 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008178 protocols.
8179
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008180 - reject :
8181 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8182 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008183 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008184
8185 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8186 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8187 for changing the default action to a reject.
8188
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008189 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8190 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8191 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8192 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008193 period.
8194
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008195 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8196 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8197 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8198 documentation.
8199
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008200 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8201
8202 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8203
8204
8205tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8206 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8208 no | no | yes | yes
8209 Arguments :
8210 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8212 as explained at the top of this document.
8213
8214 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8215
8216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008217timeout check <timeout>
8218 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8219 established.
8220
8221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8222 yes | no | yes | yes
8223 Arguments:
8224 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8225 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8226 as explained at the top of this document.
8227
8228 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8229 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8230 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8231 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008232 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8233 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8234 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008235
8236 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8237 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8238
8239 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8240 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008241 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008242
8243 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8244 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8245 forget about it.
8246
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008247 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8248 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008249
8250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008251timeout client <timeout>
8252timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8253 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8255 yes | yes | yes | no
8256 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008257 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008258 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8259 as explained at the top of this document.
8260
8261 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8262 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8263 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8264 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8265 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8266 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8267 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8268 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008269 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008270 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008271 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8272 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008273 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8274 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008275
8276 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8277 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8278 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8279 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8280 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8281 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8282
8283 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8284 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8285 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8286
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008287 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008288
8289
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008290timeout client-fin <timeout>
8291 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 yes | yes | yes | no
8294 Arguments :
8295 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8296 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8297 as explained at the top of this document.
8298
8299 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8300 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8301 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8302 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8303 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8304 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8305 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8306 down in one direction.
8307
8308 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8309 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8310 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8311
8312 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8313
8314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008315timeout connect <timeout>
8316timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8317 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8319 yes | no | yes | yes
8320 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008321 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008322 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8323 as explained at the top of this document.
8324
8325 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008326 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008327 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008328 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008329 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8330 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008331
8332 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8333 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8334 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8335 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8336 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8337 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8338
8339 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8340 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8341 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8342
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008343 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8344 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008345
8346
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008347timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8348 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8350 yes | yes | yes | yes
8351 Arguments :
8352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8354 as explained at the top of this document.
8355
8356 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8357 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8358 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8359 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8360 once the request has started to present itself.
8361
8362 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8363 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8364 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8365 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8366 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8367
8368 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8369 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8370 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8371 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8372
8373 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8374 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8375 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8376 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8377 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008378 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008379
8380 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8381 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8382 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8383 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8384
8385 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8386
8387
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008388timeout http-request <timeout>
8389 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008391 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008392 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008393 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008394 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8395 as explained at the top of this document.
8396
8397 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8398 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8399 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8400 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8401 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8402 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8403 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008404 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8405 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8406 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8407 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8408 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008409 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
8410 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008411
8412 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8413 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008414 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8415 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008416
8417 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8418 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8419 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8420 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8421 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8422
8423 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008424 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8425 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8426 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008427
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008428 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
8429 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008430
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008431
8432timeout queue <timeout>
8433 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8435 yes | no | yes | yes
8436 Arguments :
8437 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8438 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8439 as explained at the top of this document.
8440
8441 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8442 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8443 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8444 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8445 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8446
8447 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8448 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8449 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8450 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8451
8452 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8453
8454
8455timeout server <timeout>
8456timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8457 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8459 yes | no | yes | yes
8460 Arguments :
8461 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8462 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8463 as explained at the top of this document.
8464
8465 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8466 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8467 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8468 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8469 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8470 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8471 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8472
8473 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8474 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8475 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8476 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8477 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008478 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008479 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008480 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8481 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8482 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8483 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008484
8485 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8486 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8487 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8488 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8489 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8490 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8491
8492 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8493 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8494 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8495
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008496 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008497
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008498
8499timeout server-fin <timeout>
8500 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8502 yes | no | yes | yes
8503 Arguments :
8504 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8505 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8506 as explained at the top of this document.
8507
8508 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8509 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8510 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8511 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8512 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8513 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8514 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8515 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8516 situations, it should not be needed.
8517
8518 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8519 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8520 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8521
8522 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8523
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008524
8525timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008526 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8528 yes | yes | yes | yes
8529 Arguments :
8530 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8532 as explained at the top of this document.
8533
8534 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8535 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8536 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8537
8538 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8539 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8540 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8541 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008542 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008543
8544 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8545
8546
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008547timeout tunnel <timeout>
8548 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8550 yes | no | yes | yes
8551 Arguments :
8552 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8553 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8554 as explained at the top of this document.
8555
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008556 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008557 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8558 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8559 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8560 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8561 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8562 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8563 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8564 specified.
8565
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008566 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8567 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8568 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8569 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8570 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8571 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8572 state.
8573
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008574 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8575 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8576 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8577 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8578 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8579
8580 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8581 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8582 forget about it.
8583
8584 Example :
8585 defaults http
8586 option http-server-close
8587 timeout connect 5s
8588 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008589 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008590 timeout server 30s
8591 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8592
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008593 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008594
8595
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008596transparent (deprecated)
8597 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008599 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008600 Arguments : none
8601
8602 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8603 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8604 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8605 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8606 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8607 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8608 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8609 appropriate server.
8610
8611 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8612
8613 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8614 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8615
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008616 See also: "option transparent"
8617
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008618unique-id-format <string>
8619 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8621 yes | yes | yes | no
8622 Arguments :
8623 <string> is a log-format string.
8624
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008625 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8626 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8627 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8628 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008629
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008630 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8631 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8632 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8633 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8634 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8635 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8636 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8637 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008638
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008639 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8640 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008641
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008642 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008643
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008644 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008645
8646 will generate:
8647
8648 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8649
8650 See also: "unique-id-header"
8651
8652unique-id-header <name>
8653 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8655 yes | yes | yes | no
8656 Arguments :
8657 <name> is the name of the header.
8658
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008659 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8660 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008661
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008662 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008663
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008664 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008665 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8666
8667 will generate:
8668
8669 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8670
8671 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008672
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008673use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008674 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8676 no | yes | yes | no
8677 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008678 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8679 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008680
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008681 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8682 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008683
8684 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8685 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8686 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008687 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8688 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8689 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8690 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008691
8692 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8693 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8694 assign the backend.
8695
8696 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8697 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8698 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8699 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8700 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8701 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8702
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008703 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008704 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008705 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8706 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8707 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8708
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008709 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8710 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8711 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8712 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8713 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8714 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8715 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8716 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8717 cannot be forced from the request.
8718
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008719 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008720 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8721 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8722
8723 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8724 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008725
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008726
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008727use-server <server> if <condition>
8728use-server <server> unless <condition>
8729 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8731 no | no | yes | yes
8732 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008733 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008734
8735 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8736
8737 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8738 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8739 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8740
8741 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8742 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8743 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8744 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8745 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8746 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8747 matches will assign the server.
8748
8749 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8750 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8751 with the next rules until one matches.
8752
8753 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8754 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8755 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8756 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8757
8758 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8759 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8760 stripped.
8761
8762 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8763 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8764 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8765 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8766
8767 Example :
8768 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8769 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8770 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8771 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8772 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8773 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8774 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8775 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8776 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8777
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008778 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008779
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008780
87815. Bind and Server options
8782--------------------------
8783
8784The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8785depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8786settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8787written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8788described in this section.
8789
8790
87915.1. Bind options
8792-----------------
8793
8794The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8795as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8796no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8797parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8798while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8799provided immediately after the setting name.
8800
8801The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8802
8803accept-proxy
8804 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008805 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8806 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008807 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8808 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8809 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8810 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8811 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8812 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8813 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008814 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8815 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008816
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008817alpn <protocols>
8818 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8819 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8820 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8821 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8822 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8823 initial NPN extension.
8824
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008825backlog <backlog>
8826 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8827 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8828
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008829ecdhe <named curve>
8830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008831 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8832 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008833
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008834ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8836 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8837 client's certificate.
8838
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008839ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8841 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8842 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8843 error is ignored.
8844
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008845ciphers <ciphers>
8846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8847 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008848 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008849 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8850 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8851
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008852crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8854 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8855 to verify client's certificate.
8856
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008857crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8859 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8860 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8861 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8862 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8863 file.
8864
8865 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8866 are loaded.
8867
8868 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008869 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008870 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
8871 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8872 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
8873 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
8874 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
8875 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
8876 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008877
8878 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8879 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8880 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8881 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008882 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8883 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008884
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008885 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008886
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008887 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8888 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008889 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008890 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8891 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8892 clients).
8893
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008894 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8895 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8896 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8897 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8898 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8899 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8900 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8901 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8902 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8903 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8904 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8905 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8906 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8907
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01008908 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
8909 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
8910 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
8911 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
8912 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
8913
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008914crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8916 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008917 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008918 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008919
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008920crt-list <file>
8921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008922 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8923 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008924
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008925 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008926
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008927 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8928 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8929 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8930 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8931 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8932 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8933 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8934 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008935
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008936defer-accept
8937 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8938 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8939 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8940 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8941 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8942 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8943 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8944 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8945 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8946 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8947 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8948
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008949force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008950 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008951 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008952 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8953 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008954
8955force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008956 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008957 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8958 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008959
8960force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008961 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008962 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8963 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008964
8965force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008966 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008967 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8968 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008969
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008970gid <gid>
8971 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8972 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8973 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8974 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8975 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8976
8977group <group>
8978 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8979 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8980 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8981 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8982 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8983
8984id <id>
8985 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8986 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8987 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8988 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8989
8990interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008991 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8992 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8993 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8994 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8995 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8996 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8997 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008998
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008999level <level>
9000 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9001 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9002 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9003 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9004 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9005 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9006 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9007 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9008 counters).
9009 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9010 all counters).
9011
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009012maxconn <maxconn>
9013 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9014 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9015 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9016 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9017 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9018 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9019 eat all memory.
9020
9021mode <mode>
9022 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9023 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9024 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9025 UNIX sockets.
9026
9027mss <maxseg>
9028 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9029 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9030 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9031 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9032 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9033 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9034 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9035 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9036 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9037 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9038 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9039
9040name <name>
9041 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9042 page.
9043
9044nice <nice>
9045 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9046 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9047 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9048 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9049 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9050 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9051 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9052 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9053 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9054 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9055 one for an RDP socket.
9056
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009057no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009059 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009060 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009061 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9062 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009063 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009064
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009065no-tls-tickets
9066 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9067 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9068 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009069 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9070 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009071
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009072no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009074 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009075 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009076 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9077 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9078 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009079
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009080no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009081 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009082 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009083 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009084 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9085 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9086 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009087
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009088no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009089 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009090 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009091 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009092 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9093 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9094 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009095
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009096npn <protocols>
9097 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9098 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9099 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9100 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009101 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9102 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009103
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009104process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9105 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9106 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9107 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9108 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9109 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9110 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9111 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009112 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9113 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9114 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9115 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9116 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9117 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9118 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009120ssl
9121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009122 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009123 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9124 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9125 to deciphered contents.
9126
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009127strict-sni
9128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9129 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9130 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9131 See the "crt" option for more information.
9132
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009133tcp-ut <delay>
9134 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9135 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9136 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9137 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9138 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9139 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9140 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9141 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9142 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9143 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9144 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9145
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009146tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009147 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009148 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9149 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9150 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9151 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9152 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9153 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9154 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009155 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9156 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9157 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009158
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009159tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9160 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9161 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9162 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9163 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9164 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9165 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9166 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9167 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9168 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9169 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9170
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009171transparent
9172 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9173 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9174 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9175 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9176 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9177 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9178 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9179 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9180 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9181 so check for support with your vendor.
9182
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009183v4v6
9184 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9185 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9186 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9187 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009188 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009189
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009190v6only
9191 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9192 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9193 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009194 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9195 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009196
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009197uid <uid>
9198 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9199 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9200 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9201 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9202 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9203
9204user <user>
9205 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9206 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9207 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9208 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9209 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9210
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009211verify [none|optional|required]
9212 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9213 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9214 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9215 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9216 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009217 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9218 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9219 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9220 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009221
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020092225.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009223------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009225The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9226which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9227arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9228settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9229after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9230Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9231address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009233 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009234 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009236The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009237
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009238addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009239 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9240 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9241 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9242 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9243 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009244
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009245 Supported in default-server: No
9246
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009247agent-check
9248 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009249 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9250 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9251 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9252 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009253
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009254 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009255 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009256 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9257 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9258 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009259
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009260 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9261 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009262
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009263 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9264 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9265 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009266
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009267 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9268 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9269 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009270
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009271 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9272 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9273 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9274 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9275 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9276 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9277 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009278
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009279 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9280 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009281
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009282 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9283 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9284 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9285 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9286 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9287 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9288 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9289 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9290 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009291
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009292 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9293 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009294 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9295 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9296 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9297 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009298
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009299 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9300 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009301
9302 Supported in default-server: No
9303
9304agent-inter <delay>
9305 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9306 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9307
9308 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9309 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9310 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9311 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9312 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9313 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9314 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9315 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9316 of backends use the same servers.
9317
9318 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9319
9320 Supported in default-server: Yes
9321
9322agent-port <port>
9323 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9324
9325 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9326
9327 Supported in default-server: Yes
9328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009329backup
9330 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9331 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9332 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9333 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9334 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9335 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009337 Supported in default-server: No
9338
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009339ca-file <cafile>
9340 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9341 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9342 server's certificate.
9343
9344 Supported in default-server: No
9345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009346check
9347 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009348 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9349 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9350 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9351 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9352 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9353 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9354 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009355 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9356 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9357 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009358
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009359 Supported in default-server: No
9360
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009361check-send-proxy
9362 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9363 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9364 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9365 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9366 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9367 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9368 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9369
9370 Supported in default-server: No
9371
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009372check-ssl
9373 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9374 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9375 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9376 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009377 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009378 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9379 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9380 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9381 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9382
9383 Supported in default-server: No
9384
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009385ciphers <ciphers>
9386 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009387 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009388 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9389 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9390 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9391 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9392 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9393 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9394
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009395 Supported in default-server: No
9396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009397cookie <value>
9398 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9399 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9400 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9401 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9402 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9403 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9404 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009406 Supported in default-server: No
9407
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009408crl-file <crlfile>
9409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9410 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9411 to verify server's certificate.
9412
9413 Supported in default-server: No
9414
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009415crt <cert>
9416 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9417 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9418 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9419 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9420 certificate request.
9421
9422 Supported in default-server: No
9423
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009424disabled
9425 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9426 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9427 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9428 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9429 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9430
9431 Supported in default-server: No
9432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009433error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009434 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9435 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9436 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009438 Supported in default-server: Yes
9439
9440 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009442fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009443 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9444 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9445 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009447 Supported in default-server: Yes
9448
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009449force-sslv3
9450 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9451 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009452 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9453 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009454
9455 Supported in default-server: No
9456
9457force-tlsv10
9458 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009459 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9460 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009461
9462 Supported in default-server: No
9463
9464force-tlsv11
9465 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009466 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9467 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009468
9469 Supported in default-server: No
9470
9471force-tlsv12
9472 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009473 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9474 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009475
9476 Supported in default-server: No
9477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009478id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009479 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9480 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9481 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009483 Supported in default-server: No
9484
9485inter <delay>
9486fastinter <delay>
9487downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009488 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9489 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9490 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9491 between checks depending on the server state :
9492
9493 Server state | Interval used
9494 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9495 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9496 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9497 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9498 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9499 or yet unchecked. |
9500 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9501 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9502 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009503
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009504 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9505 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9506 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9507 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009508 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9509 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9510 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9511 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9512 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009514 Supported in default-server: Yes
9515
9516maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009517 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9518 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9519 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9520 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9521 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9522 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9523 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9524 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009526 Supported in default-server: Yes
9527
9528maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009529 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9530 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9531 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9532 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9533 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9534 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9535 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009537 Supported in default-server: Yes
9538
9539minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009540 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9541 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9542 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9543 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9544 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9545 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009546 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009547 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009549 Supported in default-server: Yes
9550
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009551no-ssl-reuse
9552 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9553 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9554 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9555 and for paranoid users.
9556
9557 Supported in default-server: No
9558
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009559no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009560 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9561 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009562 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009563
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009564 Supported in default-server: No
9565
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009566no-tls-tickets
9567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9568 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9569 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009570 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9571 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009572
9573 Supported in default-server: No
9574
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009575no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009576 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009577 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9578 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009579 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9580 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9581 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009582
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009583 Supported in default-server: No
9584
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009585no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009586 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009587 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9588 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009589 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9590 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9591 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009592
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009593 Supported in default-server: No
9594
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009595no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009596 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009597 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9598 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009599 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9600 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9601 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009602
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009603 Supported in default-server: No
9604
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009605non-stick
9606 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9607 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9608 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9609
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009610 Supported in default-server: No
9611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009612observe <mode>
9613 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9614 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9615 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9616 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9617 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9618 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009619 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009620
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009621 Supported in default-server: No
9622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009623 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009625on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009626 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9627 Currently, four modes are available:
9628 - fastinter: force fastinter
9629 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9630 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9631 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9632 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9633
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009634 Supported in default-server: Yes
9635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009636 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9637
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009638on-marked-down <action>
9639 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9640 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009641 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9642 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9643 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9644 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9645 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9646 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9647 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9648 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009649
9650 Actions are disabled by default
9651
9652 Supported in default-server: Yes
9653
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009654on-marked-up <action>
9655 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9656 Currently one action is available:
9657 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9658 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9659 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9660 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9661 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9662 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9663 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9664 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9665
9666 Actions are disabled by default
9667
9668 Supported in default-server: Yes
9669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009670port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009671 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9672 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9673 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9674 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9675 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9676 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009678 Supported in default-server: Yes
9679
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009680redir <prefix>
9681 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9682 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9683 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9684 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9685 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9686 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9687 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9688 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009689 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009690 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9691 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9692 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9693 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9694 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9695
9696 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009698 Supported in default-server: No
9699
9700rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009701 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9702 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9703 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009705 Supported in default-server: Yes
9706
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009707send-proxy
9708 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9709 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9710 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9711 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9712 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9713 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9714 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9715 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9716 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009717 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9718 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9719 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9720 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9721 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009722
9723 Supported in default-server: No
9724
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009725send-proxy-v2
9726 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9727 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9728 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9729 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9730 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9731 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9732 option of the "bind" keyword.
9733
9734 Supported in default-server: No
9735
9736send-proxy-v2-ssl
9737 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9738 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9739 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9740 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9741 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9742 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9743 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9744 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9745
9746 Supported in default-server: No
9747
9748send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9749 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9750 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9751 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9752 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9753 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9754 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9755 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9756 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9757 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9758
9759 Supported in default-server: No
9760
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009761slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009762 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9763 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9764 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9765 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9766 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9767 parameters :
9768
9769 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9770 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9771
9772 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9773 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9774 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9775 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9776
9777 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9778 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9779 seen as failed.
9780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009781 Supported in default-server: Yes
9782
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009783source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009784source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009785source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009786 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9787 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9788 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9789 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9790
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009791 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9792 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9793 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9794 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9795 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9796 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9797 server.
9798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009799 Supported in default-server: No
9800
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009801ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009802 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9803 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9804 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9805 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9806 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9807 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009808 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009809
9810 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009812track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009813 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9814 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9815 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9816 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009817 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009819 Supported in default-server: No
9820
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009821verify [none|required]
9822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009823 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9824 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9825 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9826 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009827 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9828 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9829 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009830
9831 Supported in default-server: No
9832
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009833verifyhost <hostname>
9834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9835 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9836 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9837 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9838 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9839 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9840
9841 Supported in default-server: No
9842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009843weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009844 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9845 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9846 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009847 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9848 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9849 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9850 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9851 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9852 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009854 Supported in default-server: Yes
9855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009856
98576. HTTP header manipulation
9858---------------------------
9859
9860In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9861response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9862request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9863which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009864against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009865
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009866If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9867to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9868but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9869HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9870stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9871because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9872a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9873still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009875This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9876in section 4.2 :
9877
9878 - reqadd <string>
9879 - reqallow <search>
9880 - reqiallow <search>
9881 - reqdel <search>
9882 - reqidel <search>
9883 - reqdeny <search>
9884 - reqideny <search>
9885 - reqpass <search>
9886 - reqipass <search>
9887 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9888 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9889 - reqtarpit <search>
9890 - reqitarpit <search>
9891 - rspadd <string>
9892 - rspdel <search>
9893 - rspidel <search>
9894 - rspdeny <search>
9895 - rspideny <search>
9896 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9897 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9898
9899With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9900is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9901parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9902prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9903Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9904
9905 \t for a tab
9906 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9907 \n for a new line (LF)
9908 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9909 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9910 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9911 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9912 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9913
9914The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9915portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9916above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9917regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
99189 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9919is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9920
9921The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9922after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9923
9924Notes related to these keywords :
9925---------------------------------
9926 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9927 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9928 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9929
9930 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9931 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9932 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9933
9934 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9935 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9936 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9937 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9938 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9939
9940 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9941 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9942 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9943 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9944 useless headers before adding new ones.
9945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009946 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009947 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9948
9949 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9950 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9951 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9952
9953 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9954 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009955 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009956
9957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099587. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9959----------------------------------
9960
9961Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9962client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9963The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9964these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9965but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9966data called patterns.
9967
9968
99697.1. ACL basics
9970---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009971
9972The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9973content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9974from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9975simple :
9976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009977 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009978 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009979 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9980 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9983adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009984
9985In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009987 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009988
9989This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9990Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9991and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009992an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9993conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9994as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9995are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009996
9997ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9998'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9999which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10000
10001There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10002performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010004The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10005specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10006this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010007methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10008ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010009
10010Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10011 - boolean
10012 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10013 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10014 - string
10015 - data block
10016
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010017Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10018converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10019would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10020The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10021which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10022
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010023Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10024keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10025fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10026which are summarized in the table below :
10027
10028 +---------------------+-----------------+
10029 | Sample or converter | Default |
10030 | output type | matching method |
10031 +---------------------+-----------------+
10032 | boolean | bool |
10033 +---------------------+-----------------+
10034 | integer | int |
10035 +---------------------+-----------------+
10036 | ip | ip |
10037 +---------------------+-----------------+
10038 | string | str |
10039 +---------------------+-----------------+
10040 | binary | none, use "-m" |
10041 +---------------------+-----------------+
10042
10043Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
10044matching method, see below.
10045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010046The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
10047 - boolean
10048 - integer or integer range
10049 - IP address / network
10050 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
10051 - regular expression
10052 - hex block
10053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010054The following ACL flags are currently supported :
10055
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010056 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
10057 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010058 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010059 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010060 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010061 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010062 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
10063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010064The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
10065read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
10066if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
10067lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
10068will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
10069beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
10070a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
10071lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
10072exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
10073
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010010074The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
10075parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
10076ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
10077a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
10078check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
10079
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010010080The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
10081socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
10082file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
10083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010084Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
10085loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
10086
10087 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
10088
10089In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
10090the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
10091case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
10092as well.
10093
10094The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
10095sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
10096do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
10097methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
10098is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
10099obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
10100followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
10101default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
10102that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
10103string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
10104
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010010105The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
10106By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
10107string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
10108resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
10109server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
10110waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
10111flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
10112function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
10113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010114There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
10115sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
10116be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010117
10118 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
10119 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010120 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
10121 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
10122 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
10123 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010124
10125 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
10126 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010127 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010128
10129 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010130 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010131
10132 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010133 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010134
10135 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
10136 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
10137
10138 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10139 binary or string samples.
10140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010141 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10142 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010144 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10145 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10146 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010148 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10149 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010151 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10152 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010154 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10155 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010157 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10158 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010159 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010161 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10162 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10163 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010164
10165For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10166request, it is possible to do :
10167
10168 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10169
10170In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10171buffer, one would use the following acl :
10172
10173 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10174
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010175On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10176possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10177
10178 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010180All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10181criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10182method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10183to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10184criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10185the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010187If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010188the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10189For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010191 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10192 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10193 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10194 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010195
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010196
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010197The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10198types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10199combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10200brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10201default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010203 +-------------------------------------------------+
10204 | Input sample type |
10205 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010206 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010207 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10208 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10209 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010210 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010211 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010212 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010213 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010214 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010215 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010216 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010217 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010218 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010219 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010220 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010221 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010222 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010223 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010224 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010225 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010226 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010227 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010228 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010229 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010230 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010231 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10232 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10233 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010234
10235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102367.1.1. Matching booleans
10237------------------------
10238
10239In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10240Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10241When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10242that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10243
10244Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10245return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10246"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10247
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102497.1.2. Matching integers
10250------------------------
10251
10252Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10253enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10254to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10255
10256Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10257matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10258lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010259
10260For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10261unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10262representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10263
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010264As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10265two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10266instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10267ranges and operators.
10268
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010269For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010270operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10271Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10272of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010274Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010275
10276 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10277 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10278 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10279 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10280 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010282For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010283
10284 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10285
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010286This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10287
10288 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10289
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200102917.1.3. Matching strings
10292-----------------------
10293
10294String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10295different forms :
10296
10297 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10298 patterns ;
10299
10300 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10301 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10302
10303 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10304 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10305
10306 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10307 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10308
10309 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10310 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10311 matches.
10312
10313 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10314 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10315 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010316
10317String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10318exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10319characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10320string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10321to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010322before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010323
10324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103257.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10326---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010327
10328Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10329they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10330possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10331passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10332the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010333the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10334match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010335
10336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200103377.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10338-------------------------------------
10339
10340It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10341not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10342a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10343to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10344digits may be used upper or lower case.
10345
10346Example :
10347 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10348 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10349
10350
103517.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10352---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010353
10354IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10355netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10356within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010357host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010358difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10359at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10360does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10361parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010362
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010363IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10364Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10365trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10366IPv6 patterns.
10367
10368HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10369following situations :
10370 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10371 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10372 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10373 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10374 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10375 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10376 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10377 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10378 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10379 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010381
103827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10383----------------------------------
10384
10385Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10386combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10387
10388 - AND (implicit)
10389 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10390 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010392A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010394 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010396Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10397indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010399For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10400"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10401requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10402is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10403
10404 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10405 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10406 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10407 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10408
10409To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10410and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10411
10412 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10413 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10414 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10415 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10416
10417 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10418 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10419 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10420 use_backend www if host_www
10421
10422It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10423expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10424be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10425the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10426
10427 The following rule :
10428
10429 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10430 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10431
10432 Can also be written that way :
10433
10434 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10435
10436It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10437to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10438simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10439sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10440good use is the following :
10441
10442 With named ACLs :
10443
10444 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10445 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10446 monitor fail if site_dead
10447
10448 With anonymous ACLs :
10449
10450 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10451
10452See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10453
10454
104557.3. Fetching samples
10456---------------------
10457
10458Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10459against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10460sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10461ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10462of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10463available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10464
10465This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10466Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10467compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10468deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10469
10470The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10471matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10472method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10473indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10474
10475As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10476when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10477mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10478the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10479ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10480
10481Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10482multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10483when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10484incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10485are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10486is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10487all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10488
10489Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10490 - name
10491 - name(arg1)
10492 - name(arg1,arg2)
10493
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010494
104957.3.1. Converters
10496-----------------
10497
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010498Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10499of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10500is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10501was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10502has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10503unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10504
10505These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10506sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10507the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10508support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010509
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010510A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10511support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10512supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10513(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10514bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010516The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010517
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010518add(<value>)
10519 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10520 result as an unsigned integer.
10521
10522and(<value>)
10523 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10524 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10525
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010526base64
10527 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10528 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10529 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10530
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010531bool
10532 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10533 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10534 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10535 presence of a flag).
10536
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010537bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10538 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10539 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10540 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10541
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010542cpl
10543 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10544 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10545
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010546crc32([<avalanche>])
10547 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10548 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10549 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10550 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10551 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10552 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10553 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10554 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10555 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10556 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10557 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10558
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010559div(<value>)
10560 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10561 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10562 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10563
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010564djb2([<avalanche>])
10565 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10566 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10567 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10568 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10569 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10570 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10571 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010572 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10573 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010574
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010575even
10576 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10577 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10578
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010579field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10580 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10581 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10582 list of chars.
10583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010584hex
10585 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10586 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10587 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10588 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010590http_date([<offset>])
10591 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10592 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10593 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10594 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10595 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10596 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010597
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010598in_table(<table>)
10599 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10600 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10601 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10602 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10603 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10604
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010605ipmask(<mask>)
10606 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10607 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10608 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10609 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10610
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010611json([<input-code>])
10612 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10613 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10614 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10615 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10616 of errors:
10617 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10618 bytes, ...)
10619 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10620 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10621
10622 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10623 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10624 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10625 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10626 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10627 are :
10628 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10629 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10630 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10631 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10632 error ;
10633 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10634 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10635
10636 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10637 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10638
10639 Example:
10640 capture request header user-agent len 150
10641 capture request header Host len 15
10642 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10643
10644 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10645 GET / HTTP/1.0
10646 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10647
10648 Output log:
10649 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10650
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010651language(<value>[,<default>])
10652 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10653 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10654 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10655 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10656 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10657 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10658 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10659 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10660 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10661 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10662 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10663 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010664
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010665 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010666
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010667 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10668 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010669
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010670 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10671 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10672 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10673 use_backend spanish if es
10674 use_backend french if fr
10675 use_backend english if en
10676 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010677
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010678lower
10679 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10680 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10681 type. The result is of type string.
10682
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010683ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10684 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10685 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10686 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10687 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10688 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10689 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10690
10691 Example :
10692
10693 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10694 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10695 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10696
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010697map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10698map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10699map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10700 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10701 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10702 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10703 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10704 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10705 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10706 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10707 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010708
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010709 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10710 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10711 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010712
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010713 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10714 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010715
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010716 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10717 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10718 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10719 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010720 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10721 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010722 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10723 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10724 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10725 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10726 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10727 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10728 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10729 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10730 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10731 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10732 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10733 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10734 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10735 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010736
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010737 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10738 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10739 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10740 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10741 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010742
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010743 Example :
10744
10745 # this is a comment and is ignored
10746 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10747 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10748 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10749 | | | `---------- value
10750 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10751 | `---------------------------- key
10752 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10753
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010754mod(<value>)
10755 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10756 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10757
10758mul(<value>)
10759 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10760 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10761 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10762
10763neg
10764 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10765 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10766 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10767 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10768
10769not
10770 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10771 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10772 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10773 absence of a flag).
10774
10775odd
10776 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10777 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10778
10779or(<value>)
10780 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10781 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10782
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010783regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010784 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10785 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10786 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10787 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10788 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10789 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10790 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10791 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10792 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10793 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10794 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10795 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10796 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10797
10798 Example :
10799
10800 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10801 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10802 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10803 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10804
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010805sdbm([<avalanche>])
10806 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10807 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10808 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10809 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10810 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10811 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10812 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010813 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10814 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010815
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010816sub(<value>)
10817 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10818 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10819 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10820
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010821table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10822 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10823 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10824 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10825 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10826 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10827 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10828
10829
10830table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10831 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10832 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10833 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10834 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10835 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10836 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10837
10838table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10839 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10840 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10841 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10842 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10843 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10844
10845table_conn_cur(<table>)
10846 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10847 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10848 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10849 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10850 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10851
10852table_conn_rate(<table>)
10853 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10854 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10855 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10856 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10857 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10858
10859table_gpc0(<table>)
10860 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10861 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10862 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10863 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10864 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10865
10866table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10867 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10868 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10869 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10870 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10871 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10872 sample fetch keyword.
10873
10874table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10878 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10879 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10880
10881table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10882 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10883 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10884 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10885 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10886 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10887 keyword.
10888
10889table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10893 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10894 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10895
10896table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10899 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10900 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10901 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10902 keyword.
10903
10904table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10908 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10909 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10910 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10911 keyword.
10912
10913table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10914 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10915 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10916 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10917 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10918 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10919 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10920 keyword.
10921
10922table_server_id(<table>)
10923 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10924 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10925 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10926 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10927 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10928 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10929
10930table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10934 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10935 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10936 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10937 keyword.
10938
10939table_sess_rate(<table>)
10940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10942 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10943 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10944 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10945 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10946 keyword.
10947
10948table_trackers(<table>)
10949 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10950 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10951 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10952 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10953 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10954 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10955 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10956 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10957 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10958 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10959
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010960upper
10961 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10962 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10963 type. The result is of type string.
10964
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010965utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10966 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10967 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10968 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10969 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10970 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10971 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10972
10973 Example :
10974
10975 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10976 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10977 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10978
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010979word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10980 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10981 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10982
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010983wt6([<avalanche>])
10984 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10985 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10986 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10987 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10988 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10989 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10990 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010991 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10992 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010993
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010994xor(<value>)
10995 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10996 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10997
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010998
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109997.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011000--------------------------------------------
11001
11002A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
11003not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
11004"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
11005The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
11006
11007always_false : boolean
11008 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11009 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11010
11011always_true : boolean
11012 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
11013 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
11014
11015avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011016 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
11018 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
11019 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
11020 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
11021 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
11022 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
11023 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
11024 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
11025 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
11026 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
11027 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
11028 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
11029 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010011030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011031be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011032 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
11033 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
11034 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
11035 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
11036 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011038be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
11039 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11040 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11041 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
11042 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
11043 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
11044 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011045
11046 Example :
11047 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
11048 backend dynamic
11049 mode http
11050 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
11051 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011053connslots([<backend>]) : integer
11054 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011055 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
11057 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050011058
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011059 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011060 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011061 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
11062
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011063 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
11064 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011065
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011066 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011067 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011068 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011069 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
11070 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011071 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011072 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011073
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011074 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
11075 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011076 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011077 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080011078
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011079date([<offset>]) : integer
11080 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
11081 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
11082 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
11083 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020011084 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
11085
11086 Example :
11087
11088 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
11089 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020011090
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020011091env(<name>) : string
11092 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
11093 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
11094 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
11095 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
11096 certain way.
11097
11098 Examples :
11099 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
11100 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
11101
11102 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
11103 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
11104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011105fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
11106 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011107 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
11108 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011109 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
11110 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
11111 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
11112 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
11113 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020011114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
11116 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11117 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
11118 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
11119 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
11120 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
11121 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
11122 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
11123 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011124
11125 Example :
11126 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
11127 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
11128 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
11129 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
11130 frontend mail
11131 bind :25
11132 mode tcp
11133 maxconn 100
11134 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
11135 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
11136 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
11137 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011138
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011139nbproc : integer
11140 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11141 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11142 and debugging purposes.
11143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011144nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11145 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11146 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11147 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011148 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11149 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11150 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011151
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011152proc : integer
11153 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11154 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11155 debugging purposes.
11156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011157queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011158 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11159 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11160 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011161 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11162 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11163 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11164 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11165 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11166
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011167rand([<range>]) : integer
11168 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11169 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11170 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11171 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11172 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011174srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11175 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11176 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11177 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11178 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11179 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11180 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11181 methods.
11182
11183srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11184 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11185 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11186 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11187 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11188 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11189 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11190 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11191
11192srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11193 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11194 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011195 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011196 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11197 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11198 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11199 overloading servers).
11200
11201 Example :
11202 # Redirect to a separate back
11203 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11204 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11205 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11206
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011207stopping : boolean
11208 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11209 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11210 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11213 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11214 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11215
11216table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11217 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11218 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11219 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11220
11221
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200112227.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011223----------------------------------
11224
11225The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11226closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11227methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11228sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11229TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011230the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11231counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11232"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011233argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11234the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11235this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011236
11237be_id : integer
11238 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11239 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11240
11241dst : ip
11242 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11243 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11244 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11245 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11246 RFC 4291.
11247
11248dst_conn : integer
11249 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11250 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11251 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11252 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11253 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11254 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11255 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11256 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011258dst_port : integer
11259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11260 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11261 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11262 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11263 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11264 an HTTP header.
11265
11266fe_id : integer
11267 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11268 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11269 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11270
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011271sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011272sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11273sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11274sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011275 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11276 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11277 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11278
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011279sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011280sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11281sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11282sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011283 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11284 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11285 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11286
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011287sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011288sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11289sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11290sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011291 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11292 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011293 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11294 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11295 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011296
11297 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11298 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011299 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11300 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11301 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011302 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11303 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11304
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011305sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011306sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11307sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11308sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011309 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11310 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11311
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011312sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011313sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11314sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11315sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011316 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11317 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11318 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11319
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011320sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011321sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11322sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11323sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011324 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11325 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11326 See also src_conn_rate.
11327
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011328sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011329sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11330sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11331sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011332 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011333 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011334
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011335sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011336sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11337sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11338sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011339 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11340 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11341 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011342 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11343 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11344 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011345
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011346sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011347sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11348sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11349sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011350 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11351 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11352 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011354sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011355sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11356sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11357sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011358 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11359 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11360 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11361 src_http_err_rate.
11362
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011363sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011364sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11365sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11366sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011367 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11368 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11369 src_http_req_cnt.
11370
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011371sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011372sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11373sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11374sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011375 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11376 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11377 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11378 src_http_req_rate.
11379
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011380sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011381sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11382sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11383sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011384 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011385 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11386 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11387 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11388 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011389
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011390 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11391 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011392 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011394sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011395sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11396sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11397sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011398 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11399 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11400 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011402sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011403sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11404sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11405sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011406 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11407 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11408 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011410sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011411sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11412sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11413sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011414 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11415 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11416 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11417 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011418 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011419 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11420
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011421sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011422sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11423sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11424sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011425 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11426 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11427 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11428 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11429 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011430 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011431
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011432sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011433sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11434sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11435sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011436 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11437 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11438 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11439
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011440sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011441sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11442sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11443sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011444 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11445 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011446 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011447 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11448 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011449 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11450 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11451 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011453so_id : integer
11454 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11455 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11456 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011458src : ip
11459 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11460 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11461 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11462 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11463 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11464 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11465 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011466
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011467 Example:
11468 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11469 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11472 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11473 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11474 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011475 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011477src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11478 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11479 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011480 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011481 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011483src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11484 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11485 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11486 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11487 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11488 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11489 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011490
11491 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11492 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11493 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11494 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011495 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011496 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11497 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011500 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011501 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011502 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011503 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011506 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11508 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011509 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11512 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11513 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11514 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011515 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011518 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011519 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011520 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011521 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011523src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011524 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011525 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011526 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11527 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011528 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11529 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11530 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011532src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11533 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11534 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011535 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011536 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011537 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011539src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11540 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11541 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11542 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11543 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011544 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11547 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11548 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11549 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011550 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011552src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11553 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11554 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11555 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011556 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011557 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011559src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11560 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11561 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11562 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011563 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011564 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11565 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011566
11567 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011568 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011569 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011571src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011572 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11573 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11574 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11575 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11576 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011578src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011579 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11580 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11581 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11582 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11583 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011585src_port : integer
11586 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11587 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11588 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11589 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011591src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11592 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011593 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11594 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11595 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011596 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011598src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11599 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11600 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11601 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11602 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011603 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011605src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11606 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11607 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11608 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11609 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11610 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11611 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11612 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11613 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011614
11615 Example :
11616 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11617 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11618 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11619 listen ssh
11620 bind :22
11621 mode tcp
11622 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011623 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011624 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011625 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011627srv_id : integer
11628 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11629 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11630 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011631
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011632
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116337.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011634----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011636The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11637closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11638when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11639usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011640future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011641
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011642ssl_bc : boolean
11643 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11644 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11645 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11646
11647ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11648 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11649 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11650
11651ssl_bc_cipher : string
11652 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11653 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11654
11655ssl_bc_protocol : string
11656 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11657 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11658
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011659ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011660 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011661 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11662 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011663
11664ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11665 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11666 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11667 if session was reused or not.
11668
11669ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11670 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11671 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011673ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11674 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11675 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11676 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11677 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11678 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011680ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11681 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11682 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11683 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11684 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011685
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011686ssl_c_der : binary
11687 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11688 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11689 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011691ssl_c_err : integer
11692 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11693 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11694 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11695 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11696 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011698ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11699 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11700 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11701 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11702 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11703 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11704 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11705 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11706 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011708ssl_c_key_alg : string
11709 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11710 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11711 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011713ssl_c_notafter : string
11714 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11715 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11716 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718ssl_c_notbefore : string
11719 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11720 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11721 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011723ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11724 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11725 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11726 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11727 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11728 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11729 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11730 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11731 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011733ssl_c_serial : binary
11734 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11735 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11736 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011738ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11739 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11740 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11741 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011742 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11743 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11744
11745 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011747ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11748 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11749 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11750 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752ssl_c_used : boolean
11753 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11754 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011756ssl_c_verify : integer
11757 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11758 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11759 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11760 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011762ssl_c_version : integer
11763 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11764 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011765
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011766ssl_f_der : binary
11767 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11768 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11769 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011771ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11772 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11773 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11774 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11775 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011776 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011777 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11778 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11779 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011781ssl_f_key_alg : string
11782 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11783 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11784 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011786ssl_f_notafter : string
11787 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11788 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11789 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011791ssl_f_notbefore : string
11792 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11793 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11794 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011796ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11797 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11798 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11799 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11800 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11801 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11802 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11803 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11804 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806ssl_f_serial : binary
11807 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11808 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11809 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011810
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011811ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11812 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11813 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11814 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011816ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11817 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11818 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11819 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011821ssl_f_version : integer
11822 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11823 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11824
11825ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011826 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11827 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11828 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011830 Example :
11831 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11832 listen http-https
11833 bind :80
11834 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11835 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11836
11837ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11838 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11839 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11840
11841ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011842 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011843 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11844 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11845 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11846 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11847 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11848 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11849 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11850 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011852ssl_fc_cipher : string
11853 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11854 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011857 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11858 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011859 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11860 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11861 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11862 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011864ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11865 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011866 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11867 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11868 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11869 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011872 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011873 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11874 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11875 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11876 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11877 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11878 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11879 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011881ssl_fc_protocol : string
11882 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11883 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011884
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011885ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011886 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011887 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11888 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011890ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11891 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11892 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11893 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11894 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011896ssl_fc_sni : string
11897 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11898 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11899 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11900 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11901 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11902
11903 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11904 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11905 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011906 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11907 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011909 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11911 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011913ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11914 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11915 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011916
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011917
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200119187.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011919------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11922sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11923only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11924For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11925be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11926can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11927sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11928for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11929content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011931payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11932 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11933 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11934 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011936payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11937 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11938 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11939 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011941req.len : integer
11942req_len : integer (deprecated)
11943 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11944 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11945 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11946 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11947 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11948 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11949 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11950 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011952req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11953 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011954 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11955 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11956 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11957 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011959 ACL alternatives :
11960 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011962req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11963 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11964 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11965 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11966 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011968 ACL alternatives :
11969 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011971 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011973req.proto_http : boolean
11974req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11975 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11976 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11977 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11978 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11979 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11980 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11981 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011983 Example:
11984 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11985 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11986 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011987 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011989req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11990rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11991 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11992 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11993 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11994 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11995 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11996 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11997 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
12000 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
12001 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
12002 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
12003 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
12004 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012006 ACL derivatives :
12007 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012009 Example :
12010 listen tse-farm
12011 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
12012 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
12013 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12014 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
12015 # apply RDP cookie persistence
12016 persist rdp-cookie
12017 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
12018 # This is only useful makes sense if
12019 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
12020 stick-table type string size 204800
12021 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
12022 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
12023 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
12026 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012028req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
12029rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
12030 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
12031 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
12032 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
12033 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012035 ACL derivatives :
12036 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012038req.ssl_hello_type : integer
12039req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12040 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12041 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
12042 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12043 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12044 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
12045 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12046 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012048req.ssl_sni : string
12049req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
12050 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
12051 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
12052 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
12053 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12054 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12055 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
12056 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
12057 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
12058 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
12059 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
12060 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
12061 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012063 ACL derivatives :
12064 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012066 Examples :
12067 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
12068 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12069 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
12070 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
12071 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020012072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012073res.ssl_hello_type : integer
12074rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
12075 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
12076 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
12077 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
12078 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
12079 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
12080 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
12081 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020012082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083req.ssl_ver : integer
12084req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
12085 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
12086 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
12087 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
12088 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
12089 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
12090 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
12091 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
12092 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
12093 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012095 ACL derivatives :
12096 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012097
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020012098res.len : integer
12099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
12100 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
12101 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
12102 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
12103 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
12104 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
12105 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
12106 content inspection.
12107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012108res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
12109 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020012110 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
12111 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
12112 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
12113 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012115res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
12116 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
12117 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
12118 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
12119 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012121 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012123wait_end : boolean
12124 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
12125 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
12126 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
12127 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
12128 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
12129 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
12130 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
12131 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012133 Examples :
12134 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
12135 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
12136 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012138 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12139 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12140 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12141 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12142 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12143 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12144 tcp-request content reject
12145
12146
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200121477.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012148--------------------------------------
12149
12150It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12151This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12152data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12153its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12154HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12155content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12156to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12157more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12158response are indexed.
12159
12160base : string
12161 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12162 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12163 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12164 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12165 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12166 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12167 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12168 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12169
12170 ACL derivatives :
12171 base : exact string match
12172 base_beg : prefix match
12173 base_dir : subdir match
12174 base_dom : domain match
12175 base_end : suffix match
12176 base_len : length match
12177 base_reg : regex match
12178 base_sub : substring match
12179
12180base32 : integer
12181 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12182 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12183 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012184 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12185 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12186 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012187
12188base32+src : binary
12189 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12190 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12191 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12192 per-URL counters.
12193
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012194capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12195 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12196 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12197 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12198
12199capture.req.method : string
12200 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12201 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12202 because it's allocated.
12203
12204capture.req.uri : string
12205 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12206 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12207 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12208 allocated.
12209
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012210capture.req.ver : string
12211 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12212 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12213 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12214
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012215capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12216 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12217 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12218 The first entry is an index of 0.
12219 See also: "capture response header"
12220
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012221capture.res.ver : string
12222 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12223 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12224 persistent flag.
12225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012226req.cook([<name>]) : string
12227cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12228 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12229 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12230 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12231 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12232 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12233 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12234 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12235 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12236
12237 ACL derivatives :
12238 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12239 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12240 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12241 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12242 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12243 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12244 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12245 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012247req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12248cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12249 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12250 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12253cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12254 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12255 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12256 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12257 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012259cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12260 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12261 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12262 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12263 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12264 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12265 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12266 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12267 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12268 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12269 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012271hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12272 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12273 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12274 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12275 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012276 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012278req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12279 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12280 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12281 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12282 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12283 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12284 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12285 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12286 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012288req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12289 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12290 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12291 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12292 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012294req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12295 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12296 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12297 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12298 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12299 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12300 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12301 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12302 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12303 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12304 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12305 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012307 ACL derivatives :
12308 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12309 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12310 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12311 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12312 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12313 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12314 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12315 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12316
12317req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12318hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12319 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12320 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12321 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12322 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12323 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12324 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12325 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12326 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12327 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12328
12329req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12330hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12331 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12332 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12333 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12334 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12335 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12336 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12337 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12338 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12339
12340req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12341hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12342 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12343 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12344 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12345 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12346 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12347 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12348 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12349
12350http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12351 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12352 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12353 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12354 basic auth is supported.
12355
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012356http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12357 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12358 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12359 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12360 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012361 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12362 basic auth is supported.
12363
12364 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012365 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12366 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12367 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12368 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012369
12370http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012371 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12372 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012373 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12374 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012376method : integer + string
12377 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12378 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12379 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12380 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12381 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12382 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12383 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012385 ACL derivatives :
12386 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012388 Example :
12389 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12390 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12391 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012393path : string
12394 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12395 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12396 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12397 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12398 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12399 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12400 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012402 ACL derivatives :
12403 path : exact string match
12404 path_beg : prefix match
12405 path_dir : subdir match
12406 path_dom : domain match
12407 path_end : suffix match
12408 path_len : length match
12409 path_reg : regex match
12410 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012411
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012412query : string
12413 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12414 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12415 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12416 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12417 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12418 which stops before the question mark.
12419
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012420req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12421 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12422 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12423 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12424 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012426req.ver : string
12427req_ver : string (deprecated)
12428 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12429 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12430 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012432 ACL derivatives :
12433 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012435res.comp : boolean
12436 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12437 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12438 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012440res.comp_algo : string
12441 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12442 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12443 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012445res.cook([<name>]) : string
12446scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12447 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12448 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12449 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451 ACL derivatives :
12452 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012454res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12455scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12456 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12457 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12458 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012460res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12461scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12462 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12463 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12464 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012466res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12467 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12468 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12469 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12470 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12471 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12472 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12473 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12474 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12475 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012477res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12478 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12479 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12480 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12481 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12482 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012484res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12485shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12486 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12487 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12488 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12489 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12490 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12491 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12492 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12493 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012495 ACL derivatives :
12496 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12497 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12498 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12499 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12500 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12501 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12502 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12503 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12504
12505res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12506shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12507 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12508 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12509 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12510 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12511 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012513res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12514shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12515 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12516 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12517 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12518 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12519 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12520 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012521
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012522res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12523 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12524 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12525 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12526 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12529shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12530 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12531 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12532 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12533 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12534 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12535 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012537res.ver : string
12538resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12539 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12540 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012542 ACL derivatives :
12543 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012545set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12546 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12547 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12548 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12549 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012551 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12552 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012554 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012556status : integer
12557 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12558 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12559 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012561url : string
12562 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12563 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12564 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12565 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12566 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12567 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12568 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012570 ACL derivatives :
12571 url : exact string match
12572 url_beg : prefix match
12573 url_dir : subdir match
12574 url_dom : domain match
12575 url_end : suffix match
12576 url_len : length match
12577 url_reg : regex match
12578 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012580url_ip : ip
12581 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12582 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12583 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12584 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12585 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12586 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12587 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589url_port : integer
12590 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12591 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12592 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12593 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012595urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12596url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12597 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12598 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12599 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12600 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12601 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12602 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12603 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12604 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12605 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607 ACL derivatives :
12608 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12609 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12610 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12611 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12612 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12613 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12614 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12615 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012616
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012618 Example :
12619 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12620 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12621 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12622 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012624urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12625 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12626 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12627 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012628
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126307.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012631---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012633Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12634every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012635order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012637ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12638---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012639FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012640HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012641HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12642HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012643HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12644HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12645HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12646HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12647LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012648METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12649METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12650METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12651METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12652METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12653METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012654RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012655REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012656TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012657WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12658---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012659
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126618. Logging
12662----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012663
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012664One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12665provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12666very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12667provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12668state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012669to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012670headers.
12671
12672In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12673about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12674send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12675
12676 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12677 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12678 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12679 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12680 at the termination.
12681
12682The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12683allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12684as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12685while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12686real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12687delay.
12688
12689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126908.1. Log levels
12691---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012692
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012693TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012694source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012695HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12696in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12697track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12698syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12699about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012700
12701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127028.2. Log formats
12703----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012704
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012705HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012706and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12707slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12708options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012709
12710 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12711 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12712 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12713 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12714 extents.
12715
12716 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12717 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12718 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12719 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12720 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12721
12722 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12723 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12724 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12725 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12726 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12727
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012728 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12729 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12730 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12731 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12732
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012733 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12734
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012735Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12736specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12737field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12738servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12739always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12740identifier.
12741
12742Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12743 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12744 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12745 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12746 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12747
12748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127498.2.1. Default log format
12750-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012751
12752This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12753as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12754format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12755
12756 Example :
12757 listen www
12758 mode http
12759 log global
12760 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12761
12762 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12763 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12764 (www/HTTP)
12765
12766 Field Format Extract from the example above
12767 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12768 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12769 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12770 4 'to' to
12771 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12772 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12773
12774Detailed fields description :
12775 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12776 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12777 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12778 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12779 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12780 and processed the connection.
12781 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12782
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012783In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12784"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12785connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12786
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012787It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12788will eventually disappear.
12789
12790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127918.2.2. TCP log format
12792---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012793
12794The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12795is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12796information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12797counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12798emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12799environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12800the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12801sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012802specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12803not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12804fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12805marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012806
12807 Example :
12808 frontend fnt
12809 mode tcp
12810 option tcplog
12811 log global
12812 default_backend bck
12813
12814 backend bck
12815 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12816
12817 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12818 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12819 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12820
12821 Field Format Extract from the example above
12822 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12823 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12824 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12825 4 frontend_name fnt
12826 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12827 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12828 7 bytes_read* 212
12829 8 termination_state --
12830 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12831 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12832
12833Detailed fields description :
12834 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012835 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12836 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12837 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12838 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12839 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012840
12841 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012842 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12843 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12844 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012845
12846 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12847 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12848 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12849 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12850
12851 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12852 and processed the connection.
12853
12854 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12855 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12856 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12857 applications.
12858
12859 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12860 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12861 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12862 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12863 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12864
12865 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12866 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12867 See "Timers" below for more details.
12868
12869 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12870 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12871 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12872 "Timers" below for more details.
12873
12874 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012875 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012876 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12877 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12878 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12879 details.
12880
12881 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12882 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12883 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12884 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12885 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12886
12887 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12888 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12889 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12890 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12891 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12892 for more details.
12893
12894 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012895 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012896 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12897 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12898 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012899 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012900
12901 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12902 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12903 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12904 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12905 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12906 caused by a denial of service attack.
12907
12908 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12909 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12910 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12911 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12912 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12913 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12914 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12915 denial of service attack.
12916
12917 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12918 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12919 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12920 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12921 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12922 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12923 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12924 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12925 be processed than on other servers.
12926
12927 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12928 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12929 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12930 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12931 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12932 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12933 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12934 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12935 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12936 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12937 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12938 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12939 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12940
12941 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12942 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12943 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12944 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12945 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12946 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12947 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12948 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12949
12950 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12951 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12952 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12953 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12954 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12955 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12956 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12957 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12958 occurs.
12959
12960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129618.2.3. HTTP log format
12962----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012963
12964The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12965is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12966the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12967are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12968emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12969generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12970"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12971which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012972frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12973is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012974
12975Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12976slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12977with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12978
12979 Example :
12980 frontend http-in
12981 mode http
12982 option httplog
12983 log global
12984 default_backend bck
12985
12986 backend static
12987 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12988
12989 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12990 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12991 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012992 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012993
12994 Field Format Extract from the example above
12995 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12996 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12997 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12998 4 frontend_name http-in
12999 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
13000 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
13001 7 status_code 200
13002 8 bytes_read* 2750
13003 9 captured_request_cookie -
13004 10 captured_response_cookie -
13005 11 termination_state ----
13006 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
13007 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
13008 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
13009 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
13010 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013011
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013012
13013Detailed fields description :
13014 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013015 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
13016 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
13017 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
13018 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
13019 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013020
13021 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013022 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
13023 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
13024 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013025
13026 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
13027 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
13028 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
13029 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
13030 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
13031
13032 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13033 and processed the connection.
13034
13035 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
13036 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
13037 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
13038
13039 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
13040 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
13041 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
13042 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
13043 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
13044 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
13045
13046 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
13047 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
13048 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
13049 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
13050 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
13051 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
13052
13053 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
13054 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
13055 See "Timers" below for more details.
13056
13057 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
13058 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
13059 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
13060 below for more details.
13061
13062 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
13063 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
13064 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
13065 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
13066 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
13067 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
13068 for more details.
13069
13070 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013071 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013072 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
13073 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
13074 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
13075 details.
13076
13077 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
13078 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
13079 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
13080
13081 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
13082 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
13083 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
13084 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
13085 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
13086 overflowing.
13087
13088 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
13089 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
13090 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
13091 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
13092 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
13093 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
13094 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
13095 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13096
13097 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
13098 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
13099 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
13100 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
13101 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
13102 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
13103 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
13104 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
13105
13106 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
13107 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
13108 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
13109 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
13110 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
13111 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
13112 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
13113
13114 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013115 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013116 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
13117 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
13118 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013119 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013120 system.
13121
13122 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
13123 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
13124 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
13125 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
13126 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
13127 caused by a denial of service attack.
13128
13129 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
13130 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
13131 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
13132 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
13133 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
13134 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
13135 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
13136 denial of service attack.
13137
13138 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13139 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13140 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13141 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13142 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13143 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13144 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13145 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13146 processed than on other servers.
13147
13148 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13149 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13150 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13151 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13152 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13153 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13154 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13155 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13156 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13157 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13158 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13159 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13160 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13161
13162 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13163 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13164 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13165 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13166 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13167 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13168 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13169 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13170
13171 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13172 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13173 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13174 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13175 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13176 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13177 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13178 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13179 occurs.
13180
13181 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13182 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13183 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13184 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13185 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13186 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13187 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13188 cookies" below for more details.
13189
13190 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13191 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13192 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13193 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13194 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13195 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13196 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13197 and cookies" below for more details.
13198
13199 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13200 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13201 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13202 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13203 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13204 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13205 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13206 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13207
13208
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200132098.2.4. Custom log format
13210------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013211
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013212The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013213mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013214
13215HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13216Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13217separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13218prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13219
13220Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13221variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13222string formats ("Q").
13223
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013224If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013225as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013226less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13227the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13228
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013229Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013230In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013231in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013232
13233Flags are :
13234 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013235 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013236
13237 Example:
13238
13239 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13240 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13241
13242At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13243
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013244 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13245 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013246
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013247the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013248
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013249 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013250 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013251 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013252
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013253and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13254
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013255 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013256 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13257
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013258Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13259
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013260 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013261 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013262 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13263 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13264 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013265 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13266 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13267 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013268 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000013269 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
13270 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
13271 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
13272 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013273 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013274 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013275 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013276 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013277 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013278 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13279 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013280 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013281 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13282 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013283 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013284 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13285 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013286 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13287 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13288 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013289 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013290 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13291 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013292 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013293 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13294 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13295 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013296 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013297 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013298 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13299 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13300 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13301 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013302 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013303 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013304 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013305 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013306 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013307 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013308 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13309 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13310 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013311 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013312 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13313 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013314 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013315 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013316 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013317 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013318
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013319 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013320
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013321
133228.2.5. Error log format
13323-----------------------
13324
13325When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13326protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13327By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13328"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13329will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13330logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13331
13332The format looks like this :
13333
13334 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13335 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13336 Connection error during SSL handshake
13337
13338 Field Format Extract from the example above
13339 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13340 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13341 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13342 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13343 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13344
13345These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13346failures.
13347
13348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133498.3. Advanced logging options
13350-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013351
13352Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13353just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13354options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13355for more information about their usage.
13356
13357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133588.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13359------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013360
13361It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13362haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13363commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13364monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13365ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13366
13367 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13368 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13369 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13370 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13371
13372 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13373 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13374 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013375 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013376 such as other load-balancers.
13377
13378 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13379 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13380 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13381
13382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133838.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13384----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013385
13386The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13387what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13388or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13389"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13390just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13391log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13392after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13393is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13394with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13395with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13396
13397
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13399------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013400
13401Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13402for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13403"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13404retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13405raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13406a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13407file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13408you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13409"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13410
13411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134128.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13413--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013414
13415Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13416multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13417them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13418"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13419logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13420error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13421and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13422too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13423useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13424alternative.
13425
13426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134278.4. Timing events
13428------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013429
13430Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13431reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13432the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13433frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13434mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13435
13436 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13437 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13438 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13439 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13440 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13441
13442 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13443 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13444 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13445 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13446 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13447
13448 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13449 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13450 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13451 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13452 connection never established.
13453
13454 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13455 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13456 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13457 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13458 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13459 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13460 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13461 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13462 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13463 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13464 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13465
13466 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13467 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13468 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13469 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013470 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013471
13472 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13473
13474 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13475 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13476 negative.
13477
13478These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13479protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13480that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013481due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013482close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13483session has been aborted on timeout.
13484
13485Most common cases :
13486
13487 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13488 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13489 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13490 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13491 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13492 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13493 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13494 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13495 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013496 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13497 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13498 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013499
13500 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13501 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13502 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13503 of ms on remote networks.
13504
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013505 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13506 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13507 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013508
13509 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13510 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13511 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13512 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13513 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13514 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13515 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13516 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13517 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13518 to the server until another one is released.
13519
13520Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13521
13522 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13523 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13524 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13525
13526 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13527 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13528 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13529
13530 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13531 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13532 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13533 flags.
13534
13535 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13536 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13537 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13538 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13539 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13540 the client connection was maintained open.
13541
13542 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013543 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013544 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13545 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13546
13547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135488.5. Session state at disconnection
13549-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013550
13551TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13552"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
135532-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13554each of which has a special meaning :
13555
13556 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13557 session to terminate :
13558
13559 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13560
13561 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13562 server explicitly refused it.
13563
13564 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13565 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13566 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13567 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013568 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13569
13570 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13571 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013572
13573 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13574 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13575 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13576 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13577 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13578
13579 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13580 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13581 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13582 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13583 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13584
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013585 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13586 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13587
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013588 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13589 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13590 backup connections when going up.
13591
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013592 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13593
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013594 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13595 send or receive data.
13596
13597 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13598 send or receive data.
13599
13600 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13601 with nothing left in the buffers.
13602
13603 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13604
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013605 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013606 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13607
13608 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13609 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13610 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13611 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13612 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13613
13614 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13615 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13616
13617 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13618 server (HTTP only).
13619
13620 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13621
13622 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13623 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13624 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13625
13626 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13627 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13628 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13629
13630 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13631
13632 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13633 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13634
13635 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13636 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13637 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13638
13639 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13640 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013641 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13642 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013643
13644 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13645 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13646 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13647 another server.
13648
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013649 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013650 server.
13651
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013652 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13653 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13654 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13655 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13656
13657 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13658 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13659 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13660 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13661
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013662 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13663 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13664 "use-server" rule).
13665
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013666 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13667
13668 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13669 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13670
13671 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13672
13673 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13674 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13675 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13676
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013677 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13678 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013679 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013680 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13681 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13682
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013683 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13684
13685 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13686 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13687
13688 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13689
13690 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13691
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013692The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13693was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013694helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13695starvation, attacks, etc...
13696
13697The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13698alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13699easier finding and understanding.
13700
13701 Flags Reason
13702
13703 -- Normal termination.
13704
13705 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13706 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13707 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13708 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13709
13710 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13711 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13712 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13713 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13714 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13715 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013717 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13718 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013719 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013720
13721 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13722 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13723 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13724
13725 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13726 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13727 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13728 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13729 the server takes too long to respond.
13730
13731 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13732 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13733 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13734 long a time to respond.
13735
13736 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13737 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13738 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13739 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013740 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
13741 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013742
13743 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13744 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13745 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13746 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13747 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013748 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013749 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
13750 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
13751 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
13752 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
13753 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
13754 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
13755 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
13756 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
13757 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
13758 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
13759 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
13760 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013761
13762 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13763 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013764 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13765 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13766 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13767 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013768
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013769 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13770 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13771
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013772 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013773 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13774 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13775 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13776 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13777 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13778
13779 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13780 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13781 503 or 504 here.
13782
13783 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13784 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13785 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13786 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13787 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13788
13789 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13790 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013791 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013792 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13793 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13794
13795 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13796 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13797 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13798 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13799 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13800 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13801 between haproxy and the server.
13802
13803 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13804 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13805 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13806 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13807 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13808 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13809 solution is to fix the application.
13810
13811 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13812 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13813 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13814 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13815 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13816 external attacks.
13817
13818 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13819 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013820 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013821 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13822 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13823
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013824 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13825 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13826 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013827 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13828 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013829
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013830 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13831 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13832 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13833 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013834 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13835 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13836 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13837 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13838 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013839
13840 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13841 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13842 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13843 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13844
13845 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13846 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13847 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13848 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13849
13850 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13851 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13852 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13853 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13854
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013855The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13856persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13857important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13858re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13859
13860 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13861
13862 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13863 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13864 set on a GET request.
13865
13866 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13867 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013868 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013869 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13870
13871 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13872 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13873 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13874
13875 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13876 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13877 already got a cookie.
13878
13879 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13880 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13881 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13882 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13883 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13884
13885 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13886 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13887 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13888
13889 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13890 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13891 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13892
13893 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13894 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13895
13896 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13897 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13898 then advertised in the response.
13899
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139018.6. Non-printable characters
13902-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013903
13904In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13905consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13906converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13907prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13908being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13909escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13910is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13911'}' when logging headers.
13912
13913Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13914issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13915containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13916
13917Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13918the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13919performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13920
13921
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139228.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13923---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013924
13925Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13926achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013927section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013928cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13929the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13930the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013931locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013932not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13933user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13934a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13935wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13936
13937 Examples :
13938 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13939 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13940
13941 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13942 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13943
13944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139458.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13946---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013947
13948Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13949proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13950the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13951server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13952
13953Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13954response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013955section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013956
13957It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013958time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13959appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013960are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13961and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13962follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13963request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13964in the logs.
13965
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013966As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13967frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13968an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13969
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013970 Example :
13971 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13972 listen proxy-out
13973 mode http
13974 option httplog
13975 option logasap
13976 log global
13977 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13978
13979 # log the name of the virtual server
13980 capture request header Host len 20
13981
13982 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13983 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13984
13985 # log the beginning of the referrer
13986 capture request header Referer len 20
13987
13988 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13989 capture response header Server len 20
13990
13991 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13992 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13993
13994 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13995 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13996
13997 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13998 capture response header Via len 20
13999
14000 # log the URL location during a redirection
14001 capture response header Location len 20
14002
14003 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
14004 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
14005 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14006 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
14007 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
14008
14009 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14010 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14011 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14012 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014013 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014014
14015 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
14016 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
14017 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
14018 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
14019 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014020 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014021
14022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140238.9. Examples of logs
14024---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014025
14026These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
14027them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
14028reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
14029
14030 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
14031 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14032 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14033
14034 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
14035 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
14036
14037 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
14038 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
14039 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
14040
14041 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
14042 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
14043
14044 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
14045 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
14046 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
14047
14048 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014049 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014050 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
14051 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
14052
14053 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
14054 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
14055 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
14056
14057 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
14058 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020014059 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014060 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
14061 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
14062 to return the 502 and not the server.
14063
14064 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014065 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014066
14067 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
14068 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
14069 Nothing was sent to any server.
14070
14071 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
14072 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
14073
14074 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
14075 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
14076 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
14077 send a 408 return code to the client.
14078
14079 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
14080 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
14081
14082 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
14083 5 seconds ("c----").
14084
14085 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
14086 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014087 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014088
14089 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014090 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014091 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
14092 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
14093 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
14094 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
14095 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014096
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140989. Statistics and monitoring
14099----------------------------
14100
14101It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
14102mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
14103CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
14104Unix socket.
14105
14106
141079.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014108---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010014109
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014110The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020014111page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
14112begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
14113represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
14114use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
14115('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
14116(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
14117text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
14118do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
14119use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010014120
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014121In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
14122that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
14123S (Servers).
14124
14125 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
14126 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
14127 any name for server/listener)
14128 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
14129 number queued without a server assigned.
14130 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
14131 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
14132 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
14133 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
14134 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
14135 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
14136 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
14137 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
14138 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
14139 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
14140 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
14141 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14142 "option checkcache".
14143 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14144 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14145 - read error from the client
14146 - client timeout
14147 - client closed connection
14148 - various bad requests from the client.
14149 - request was tarpitted.
14150 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14151 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14152 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14153 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14154 active servers).
14155 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14156 Some other errors are:
14157 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14158 - failure applying filters to the response.
14159 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14160 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14161 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14162 switched away from.
14163 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
14164 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
14165 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
14166 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
14167 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14168 the server is up.)
14169 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14170 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14171 counters for each server.
14172 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14173 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14174 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14175 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14176 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14177 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14178 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14179 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14180 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14181 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14182 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14183 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14184 of times that server was selected.
14185 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14186 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14187 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14188 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14189 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14190 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014191 UNK -> unknown
14192 INI -> initializing
14193 SOCKERR -> socket error
14194 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080014195 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014196 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14197 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14198 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14199 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14200 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14201 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14202 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14203 disable-on-404
14204 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14205 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14206 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014207 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14208 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14209 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14210 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14211 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14212 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14213 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14214 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14215 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14216 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14217 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14218 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14219 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14220 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14221 (inc. in eresp)
14222 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14223 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14224 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14225 (CPU/BW limit)
14226 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14227 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14228 server/backend
14229 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14230 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14231 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14232 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14233 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14234 (0 for TCP)
14235 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14236 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014237
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142399.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014240-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014241
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014242The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14243necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14244A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14245issuing commands by hand :
14246
14247 global
14248 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14249 stats timeout 2m
14250
14251It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14252the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14253never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14254situations :
14255
14256 global
14257 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14258 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14259 stats timeout 2m
14260
14261To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14262swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14263to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14264syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14265
14266 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14267 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14268
14269The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14270script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14271for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14272
14273The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14274that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14275editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14276(eg: watch a counter).
14277
14278The socket supports two operation modes :
14279 - interactive
14280 - non-interactive
14281
14282The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14283this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14284sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14285mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14286commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14287example :
14288
14289 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14290
14291The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14292entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14293for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14294sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14295"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14296after processing the last command of the same line.
14297
14298For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14299"prompt" command :
14300
14301 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14302 prompt
14303 > show info
14304 ...
14305 >
14306
14307Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14308delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14309that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14310parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014311
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014312It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14313on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14314own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014315
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014316The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14317If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14318all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14319it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14320
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014321add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014322 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14323 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14324 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14325 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014326
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014327add map <map> <key> <value>
14328 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14329 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014330 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14331 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14332 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014333
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014334clear counters
14335 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14336 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14337 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14338 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14339 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14340
14341clear counters all
14342 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14343 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14344 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14345
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014346clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014347 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14348 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14349 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014350
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014351clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014352 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14353 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14354 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014355
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014356clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14357 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14358
14359 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14360 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14361 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14362 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14363 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14364 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14365
14366 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14367
14368 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14369 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14370 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14371 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14372 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14373 the ACLs :
14374
14375 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14376 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14377 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14378 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14379 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14380 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14381
14382 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014383 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14384 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014385
14386 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014387 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014388 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014389 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14390 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14391 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14392 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014393
14394 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14395
14396 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014397 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014398 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14399 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014400 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14401 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14402 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014403
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014404del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14405 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014406 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14407 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14408 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14409 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014410
14411del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014412 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014413 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14414 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14415 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14416 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014417
14418disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014419 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14420
14421 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14422 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14423 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14424 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14425 re-enabled using enable agent.
14426
14427 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14428 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14429 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14430 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14431 otherwise unchanged.
14432
14433 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14434 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14435 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14436
14437 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14438 level "admin".
14439
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014440disable frontend <frontend>
14441 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14442 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14443 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14444 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14445 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14446 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14447 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14448 on the stats page.
14449
14450 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14451 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14452
14453 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14454 level "admin".
14455
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014456disable health <backend>/<server>
14457 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14458 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14459 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14460 agent check forces it down.
14461
14462 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14463 level "admin".
14464
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014465disable server <backend>/<server>
14466 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14467 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14468 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14469 during the maintenance.
14470
14471 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14472 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14473
14474 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014475 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014476
14477 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14478 level "admin".
14479
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014480enable agent <backend>/<server>
14481 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14482
14483 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14484 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14485
14486 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14487 level "admin".
14488
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014489enable frontend <frontend>
14490 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14491 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14492 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14493 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14494 which was disabled.
14495
14496 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14497 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14498
14499 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14500 level "admin".
14501
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014502enable health <backend>/<server>
14503 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14504 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14505
14506 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14507 level "admin".
14508
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014509enable server <backend>/<server>
14510 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14511 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14512
14513 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014514 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014515
14516 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14517 level "admin".
14518
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014519get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014520get acl <acl> <value>
14521 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14522 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14523 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14524 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14525 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014526
14527 The first two words are:
14528
14529 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14530 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14531 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14532
14533 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14534
14535 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14536
14537 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14538
14539 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14540 interpretation of the case.
14541
14542 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14543 useful with regular expressions.
14544
14545 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14546 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14547
14548 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14549 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14550 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14551
14552 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14553
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014554get weight <backend>/<server>
14555 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14556 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14557 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14558 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14559 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014560 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014561
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014562help
14563 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14564 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014565
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014566prompt
14567 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14568 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14569 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14570 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14571 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14572 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14573 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14574 command.
14575
14576quit
14577 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014578
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014579set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014580 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14581 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14582 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014583
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014584set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014585 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14586 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14587 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14588 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14589 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014590 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14591 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14592
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014593set maxconn global <maxconn>
14594 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14595 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14596 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14597 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14598 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14599 setting.
14600
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014601set rate-limit connections global <value>
14602 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14603 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14604 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14605 is passed in number of connections per second.
14606
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014607set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14608 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14609 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014610 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14611 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014612
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014613set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14614 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14615 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14616 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14617 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14618
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014619set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14620 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14621 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14622 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14623 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14624 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14625
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014626set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14627 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14628 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14629 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14630
14631set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14632 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14633 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14634 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14635
14636set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14637 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14638 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14639 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14640 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14641 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14642 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14643 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14644 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14645
14646set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14647 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14648 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14649
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014650set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14651 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14652 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14653 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14654 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14655
14656 Example:
14657 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14658 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14659 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14660 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14661
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014662set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014663 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14664 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14665 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14666 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014667 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14668 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014669
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014670set timeout cli <delay>
14671 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14672 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14673 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14674
14675set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14676 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14677 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014678 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14679 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14680 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14681 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14682 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14683 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14684 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14685 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14686 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14687 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14688 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14689 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14690 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014691
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014692show errors [<iid>]
14693 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14694 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014695 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14696 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14697 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014698
14699 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14700 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14701 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14702 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14703 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14704 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14705 are reported too.
14706
14707 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14708 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14709 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14710 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14711 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14712 code.
14713
14714 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14715 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14716 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14717 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14718 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14719 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14720 line.
14721
14722 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014723 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14724 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014725 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14726 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14727
14728 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14729 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14730 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14731 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14732 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14733 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14734 00204+ minal\r\n
14735 00211 \r\n
14736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014737 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014738 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14739 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14740 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14741 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14742 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14743 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014744
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014745show info
14746 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14747
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014748show map [<map>]
14749 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014750 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14751 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14752 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14753 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14754 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14755 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014756
14757show acl [<acl>]
14758 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014759 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14760 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14761 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14762 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14763 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014764
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014765show pools
14766 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14767 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14768 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14769 the pools.
14770
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014771show sess
14772 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014773 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14774 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14775
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014776show sess <id>
14777 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14778 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14779 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14780 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14781 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014782 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14783 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14784
14785 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14786 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014787
14788show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14789 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14790 possible to dump only selected items :
14791 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14792 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14793 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14794 for example:
14795 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14796 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14797 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14798
14799 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014800 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14801 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014802 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14803 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14804 Nbproc: 1
14805 Process_num: 1
14806 (...)
14807
14808 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14809 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14810 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14811 (...)
14812 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14813
14814 $
14815
14816 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14817 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14818 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14819 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014820 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014821
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014822show table
14823 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14824 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14825 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14826 entries currently in use.
14827
14828 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014829 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014830 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14831 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014832
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014833show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014834 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14835 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14836 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014837 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14838
14839 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14840 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14841 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14842 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14843 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14844
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014845 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14846 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14847 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14848 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14849 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14850 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14851
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014852
14853 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014854 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14855 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014856
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014857 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014858 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014859 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014860 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14861 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14862 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14863 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014864
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014865 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014866 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014867 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14868 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014869
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014870 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14871 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014872 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014873 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14874 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014875
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014876 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14877 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014878 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014879 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14880 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14881
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014882 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14883 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14884 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14885 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14886 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14887
14888 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14889 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14890 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014891 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14892 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014893 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14894 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014895
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014896shutdown frontend <frontend>
14897 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14898 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14899 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14900 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14901 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14902 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14903 once it is terminated.
14904
14905 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14906 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14907
14908 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14909 level "admin".
14910
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014911shutdown session <id>
14912 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14913 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14914 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14915 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14916 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14917 flag in the logs.
14918
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014919shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014920 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14921 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14922 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14923 'K' flag in the logs.
14924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014925/*
14926 * Local variables:
14927 * fill-column: 79
14928 * End:
14929 */